WO2004103996A1 - Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds - Google Patents

Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2004103996A1
WO2004103996A1 PCT/CA2004/000750 CA2004000750W WO2004103996A1 WO 2004103996 A1 WO2004103996 A1 WO 2004103996A1 CA 2004000750 W CA2004000750 W CA 2004000750W WO 2004103996 A1 WO2004103996 A1 WO 2004103996A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
alkyl
cycloalkyl
compound according
substituted
compound
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/CA2004/000750
Other languages
French (fr)
Inventor
Montse Llinas-Brunet
Murray D. Bailey
Punit Bhardwaj
Josée BORDELEAU
Pasquale Forgione
Elise Ghiro
Vida Gorys
Nathalie Goudreau
Sylvie Goulet
Teddy Halmos
Jean Rancourt
Original Assignee
Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh
Boehringer Ingelheim Pharma Gmbh & Co Kg
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Family has litigation
First worldwide family litigation filed litigation Critical https://patents.darts-ip.com/?family=33476973&utm_source=google_patent&utm_medium=platform_link&utm_campaign=public_patent_search&patent=WO2004103996(A1) "Global patent litigation dataset” by Darts-ip is licensed under a Creative Commons Attribution 4.0 International License.
Priority to AU2004240704A priority Critical patent/AU2004240704B9/en
Priority to EA200501689A priority patent/EA009295B1/en
Priority to KR1020057022088A priority patent/KR101115294B1/en
Priority to PL04733750T priority patent/PL1654261T3/en
Priority to SI200430588T priority patent/SI1654261T1/en
Priority to JP2006529495A priority patent/JP4447603B2/en
Priority to EP04733750A priority patent/EP1654261B1/en
Priority to DK04733750T priority patent/DK1654261T3/en
Priority to YUP-2005/0871A priority patent/RS51294B/en
Priority to CA2522577A priority patent/CA2522577C/en
Priority to MEP-583/08A priority patent/MEP58308A/en
Priority to NZ544076A priority patent/NZ544076A/en
Priority to DE602004010137T priority patent/DE602004010137T2/en
Priority to MXPA05012545A priority patent/MXPA05012545A/en
Priority to BRPI0410456A priority patent/BRPI0410456B8/en
Application filed by Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh, Boehringer Ingelheim Pharma Gmbh & Co Kg filed Critical Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh
Publication of WO2004103996A1 publication Critical patent/WO2004103996A1/en
Priority to IL172013A priority patent/IL172013A/en
Priority to NO20056047A priority patent/NO332056B1/en
Priority to HR20080014T priority patent/HRP20080014T3/en

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D417/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00
    • C07D417/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00 containing three or more hetero rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/435Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/47Quinolines; Isoquinolines
    • A61K31/4709Non-condensed quinolines and containing further heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K38/00Medicinal preparations containing peptides
    • A61K38/04Peptides having up to 20 amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K38/06Tripeptides
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K38/00Medicinal preparations containing peptides
    • A61K38/16Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K38/17Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans
    • A61K38/19Cytokines; Lymphokines; Interferons
    • A61K38/21Interferons [IFN]
    • A61K38/212IFN-alpha
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/16Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system for liver or gallbladder disorders, e.g. hepatoprotective agents, cholagogues, litholytics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/14Antivirals for RNA viruses
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K5/00Peptides containing up to four amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K5/04Peptides containing up to four amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof containing only normal peptide links
    • C07K5/08Tripeptides
    • C07K5/0802Tripeptides with the first amino acid being neutral
    • C07K5/0804Tripeptides with the first amino acid being neutral and aliphatic
    • C07K5/0808Tripeptides with the first amino acid being neutral and aliphatic the side chain containing 2 to 4 carbon atoms, e.g. Val, Ile, Leu
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K5/00Peptides containing up to four amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K5/04Peptides containing up to four amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof containing only normal peptide links
    • C07K5/08Tripeptides
    • C07K5/0827Tripeptides containing heteroatoms different from O, S, or N
    • YGENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
    • Y02TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02ATECHNOLOGIES FOR ADAPTATION TO CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02A50/00TECHNOLOGIES FOR ADAPTATION TO CLIMATE CHANGE in human health protection, e.g. against extreme weather
    • Y02A50/30Against vector-borne diseases, e.g. mosquito-borne, fly-borne, tick-borne or waterborne diseases whose impact is exacerbated by climate change

Definitions

  • the present invention relates to compounds, processes for their synthesis, compositions and methods for the treatment of hepatitis C virus (HCV) infection.
  • HCV hepatitis C virus
  • the present invention provides novel peptide analogs, pharmaceutical compositions containing such analogs and methods for using these analogs in the treatment of HCV infection.
  • Hepatitis C virus is the major etiological agent of post-transfusion and community-acquired non-A non-B hepatitis worldwide. It is estimated that over 200 million people worldwide are infected by the virus. A high percentage of carriers become chronically infected and many progress to chronic liver disease, so-called chronic hepatitis C. This group is in turn at high risk for serious liver disease such as liver cirrhosis, hepatocellular carcinoma and terminal liver disease leading to death.
  • HCV The mechanism by which HCV establishes viral persistence and causes a high rate of chronic liver disease has not been thoroughly elucidated. It is not known how HCV interacts with and evades the host immune system. In addition, the roles of cellular and humoral immune responses in protection against HCV infection and disease have yet to be established. Immunoglobulins have been reported for prophylaxis of transfusion-associated viral hepatitis, however, the Center for Disease Control does not presently recommend immunoglobulin treatment for this purpose. The lack of an effective protective immune response is hampering the development of a vaccine or adequate post-exposure prophylaxis measures, so in the near-term, hopes are firmly pinned on antiviral interventions.
  • interferon was the only available therapy of proven benefit approved in the clinic for patients with chronic hepatitis C.
  • the sustained response rate is low, and interferon treatment also induces severe side-effects (i.e. retinopathy, thyroiditis, acute pancreatitis, depression) that diminish the quality of life of treated patients.
  • interferon in combination with ribavirin has been approved for patients non-responsive to IFN alone.
  • the side effects caused by IFN are not alleviated with this combination therapy.
  • Pegylated forms of interferons such as PEG-lntron® and Pegasys® can apparently partially address these deleterious side-effects but antiviral drugs still remain the avenue of choice for oral treatment of HCV.
  • HCV is an enveloped positive strand RNA virus in the Flaviviridae family.
  • the single strand HCV RNA genome is approximately 9500 nucleotides in length and has a single open reading frame (ORF) encoding a single large polyprotein of about 3000 amino acids. In infected cells, this polyprotein is cleaved at multiple sites by cellular and viral proteases to produce the structural and non-structural (NS) proteins.
  • NS structural and non-structural
  • the generation of mature nonstructural proteins (NS2, NS3, NS4A, NS4B, NS5A, and NS5B) is effected by two viral proteases.
  • the first one cleaves at the NS2-NS3 junction (henceforth referred to as NS2/3 protease); the second one is a serine protease contained within the N- terminal region of NS3 (NS3 protease) and mediates all the subsequent cleavages downstream of NS3, both in cis, at the NS3-NS4A cleavage site, and in trans, for the remaining NS4A-NS4B, NS4B-NS5A, NS5A-NS5B sites.
  • the NS4A protein appears to serve multiple functions, acting as a cofactor for the NS3 protease and possibly assisting in the membrane localization of NS3 and other viral replicase components.
  • NS3 protease The complex formation of the NS3 protease with NS4A seems necessary to the processing events, enhancing the proteolytic efficiency at all of the sites.
  • the NS3 protein also exhibits nucleoside triphosphatase and RNA helicase activities.
  • NS5B is a RNA-dependent RNA polymerase that is involved in the replication of HCV.
  • a general strategy for the development of antiviral agents is to inactivate virally encoded enzymes that are essential for the replication of the virus.
  • NS3/NS4A protease may represent a dual therapeutic target, the inhibition of which may both block viral replication and restore interferon response of HCV infected cells.
  • R 2 is an unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted quinolinyl residue as defined therein, are described as hepatitis C viral NS3 protease inhibitors, an enzyme essential for the replication of the hepatitis C virus.
  • the present invention provides tripeptide compounds that have improved potency against the HCV NS3 protease. Furthermore, compounds being highly active in cell culture are provided.
  • An advantage of one aspect of the present invention resides in the fact that compounds according to this invention specifically inhibit the NS3 protease and do not show significant inhibitory activity against other human serine proteases such as human leukocyte elastase (HLE), or cysteine proteases such as human liver cathepsin B (Cat B).
  • HLE human leukocyte elastase
  • Cat B cysteine proteases
  • compounds as provided by this invention exhibit unexpected advantages. In general they show one or more of the following advantages:
  • B is (C ⁇ . ⁇ o)alkyl, (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, or (C 1-4 )alkyl-(C - )cycloalkyl, a) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri- substituted with (C ⁇ .
  • alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di- substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and ⁇ -(C ⁇ alkyl; and c) wherein each of said alkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with halogen; and d) wherein each of said cycloalkyl groups being 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered having optionally one (for the 4-, 5, 6, or 7-membered) or two (for the 5-, 6- or 7-membered) -CH 2 -groups not directly linked to each other replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C- atoms;
  • X is O or NH;
  • R 3 is (C 2 - 8 )alkyl, (C 3 . 7 )cycloalkyl or (C 1-3 )alkyl-(C3. 7 )cycloalkyl, wherein each of said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri- substituted with (C 1-4 )alkyl;
  • is H, halogen, (C 1-4 )alkyl, -OH, -O-(C 1-4 )alkyl, -NH 2 , -NH(C 1-4 )alkyl or -N((C 1-4 )alkyl) 2 ;
  • L 1 , L 2 are each independently halogen, cyano, (C 1- )alkyl, -S-(C 1 ⁇ )alkyl, -SO-(C ⁇ -4 )alkyl, or-SO 2 -(C 1-4 )alkyl, wherein each of said alkyl groups is optionally substituted with from one to three halogen atoms; and either 1 or L 2 (but not both at the same time) may also be H; or
  • L° and L 1 or L° and 2 may be covalently bonded to form, together with the two C-atoms to which they are linked, a 5- or 6-membered carbocyclic ring wherein one or two -CH 2 -groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced each independently by -O- or NR a wherein R a is H or (C 1-4 )alkyl, and wherein said carbo- or heterocyclic ring is optionally mono- or di-substituted with (C 1-4 )aikyl;
  • R 2 is R 20 , -NR 22 COR 20 , -NR 22 COOR 20 -NR 22 R 21 and -NR 22 CONR 21 R 23 , wherein R 20 is selected from (C . a )alkyl, (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl and (C 1- )alkyl- (C 3-7 )cycloaIkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C ⁇ _ 3 )alkyl;
  • R 21 is H or R 20 as defined above, R 22 and R 23 are independently selected from H and methyl,
  • R 1 is ethyl or vinyl
  • R c is hydroxy or NHSO 2 R s wherein R s is (C ⁇ -6 )alkyl, (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, (C ⁇ . 6 )alkyl- (C 3-7 )cycloaIkyl, phenyl, naphthyl, pyridinyl, (C 1-4 )alkyl-phenyl, (C 1-4 )alkyl- naphthyl or (C -4 )alkyl-pyridinyl; each of which optionally being mono-, di- or tri-substituted with substituents selected from halogen, hydroxy, cyano, (C 1-4 )alkyl, O-(C 1 .
  • R N2 and R N1 are linked, together with the nitrogen to which they are bonded, to form a 3- to 7-membered monocyclic saturated or unsaturated heterocycle or a 9- or 10-membered bicyclic saturated or unsaturated heterocycle, each of which optionally containing from one to three further heteroatoms independently selected from N, S and O, and each of which being optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from halogen, (C 1-6 )alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, ⁇ -(d ⁇ alkyl, -NH 2 , -NH(C 1-4 )alkyl, -CO-NH 2) -CO-NH(C 1-4 )alkyl, -CO-N((C ⁇ -4 )alkyl) 2 , -COOH, and -COO(C 1-6 )alkyl;
  • composition comprising an anti-hepatitis C virally effective amount of a compound of formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, in admixture with at least one pharmaceutically acceptable carrier medium or auxiliary agent.
  • the pharmaceutical composition according to this invention further comprises a therapeuticaily effective amount of at least one other antiviral agent.
  • Another important aspect of the invention involves a method of treating or ⁇ preventing a hepatitis C viral infection in a mammal by administering to the mammal an anti-hepatitis C virally effective amount of a compound of formula I, a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, or a composition as described above, alone or in combination with at least one other antiviral agent, administered together or separately.
  • a compound of formula I or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, as described herein, for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of hepatitis C viral infection in mammal.
  • P1 , P2, and P3 refer to the position of the amino acid residues starting from the C-ferminus end of the peptide analogs and extending towards the N-terminus (i.e. P1 refers to position 1 from the C-terminus, P2: second position from the C-terminus, etc.) (see Berger A. & Schechter I., Transactions of the Royal Society London series B257. 249-264 (1970)).
  • (1 R, 2S)-vinyl-ACCA refers to a compound of formula:
  • (C 1 . n )alkyl as used herein, either alone or in combination with another substituent, means acyclic, straight or branched chain alkyl substituents containing from 1 to n carbon atoms.
  • “(C ⁇ -6 )alkyr includes, but is not limited to, methyl, ethyl, n- propyl, n-butyl, 1-methylethyl (i-propyl), 1-methylpropyl, 2-methylpropyl,.1,1- dimethylethyl (te/f-butyl), pentyl and hexyl.
  • Me and Pr denote a methyl group and n-propyl respectively.
  • (C 3-7 )cycloalky . r as used herein, either alone or in combination with another substituent, means a cycloalkyl substituent containing from 3 to 7 carbon atoms and includes, but is not limited to, cyclopropyl, cyciobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl and cycloheptyl.
  • (C ⁇ -n )alkyl-(C 3 . 7 )cycloalkyl as used herein means an alkylene radical containing 1 to n carbon atoms to which a cycloalkyl radical containing from 3 to 7 carbon atoms is directly linked;and includes, but is not limited to, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, 1-cyclopentylethyl, 2-cyclopentylethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, 1-cyclohexylethyl, 2-cyclohexylethyl and cycloheptylpropyl.
  • aryl or "C 6 or C 10 aryl” as used herein interchangeably, either alone or in combination with another radical, means either an aromatic monocyclic group containing 6 carbon atoms or an aromatic bicyclic group containing 10 carbon atoms.
  • Aryl includes, but is not limited to, phenyl, 1 -naphthyl or 2-naphthyl.
  • (C ⁇ -n )alkyl-aryl means an alkyl radical containing from 1 to n carbon atoms to which an aryl is bonded.
  • Examples of (C 1-3 )alkyl-aryl include, but are not limited to, benzyl (phenylmethyl), 1-phenylethyl, 2-phenylethyl and phenylpropyl.
  • O-(C ⁇ -n )alkyl or "(C 1-n )alkoxy" as used herein, either alone or in combination with another radical, means the radical -O-(C ⁇ -n )alky! wherein alkyl is as defined above containing from 1 to n carbon atoms, and includes methoxy, ethoxy, propoxy, 1-methylethoxy, butoxy and 1,1-dimethylethoxy.
  • alkyl is as defined above containing from 1 to n carbon atoms, and includes methoxy, ethoxy, propoxy, 1-methylethoxy, butoxy and 1,1-dimethylethoxy.
  • the latter radical is known commonly as terf-butoxy.
  • halo or halogen as used herein means a halogen substituent selected from fluoro, chloro, bromo or iodo.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable ester as used herein, either alone or in combination with another substituent, means esters of the compound of formula I in which any of the carboxyl functions of the molecule, but preferably the carboxy terminus, is replaced by an alkoxycarbonyl function:
  • the R moiety of the ester is selected from alkyl (including, but not limited to,, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, t-butyl, n-butyl); alkoxyalkyl (including, but not limited to methoxymethyl); alkoxyacyl (including, but not limited to acetoxymethyl); alkyl-aryl (including, but not limited to benzyl); aryloxyalkyl (including, but not limited to phenoxymethyl); aryl (including, but not limited to phenyl), optionally substituted with halogen, (C ⁇ -4 )alkyl or (C 1- )alkoxy.
  • alkyl including, but not limited to,, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, t-butyl, n-butyl
  • alkoxyalkyl including, but not limited to methoxymethyl
  • alkoxyacyl including, but not limited to acetoxymethyl
  • any alkyl moiety present advantageously contains 1 to 16 carbon atoms, particularly 1 to 6 carbon atoms.
  • Any aryl moiety present in such esters advantageously comprises a phenyl group.
  • esters may be a C 1-16 alkyl ester, an unsubstituted benzyl ester or a benzyl ester substituted with at least one halogen, C 1-6 alkyl, C 1-6 alkoxy, nitro or trifluoromethyl.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable salt means a salt of a compound of formula (I) which is, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of humans and lower animals without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response, and the like, commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio, generally water or oil-soluble or dispersible, and effective for their intended use.
  • pharmaceutically-acceptable acid addition salts and pharmaceutically-acceptable base addition salts. Lists of suitable salts are found in, e.g., S.M. Birge et al., J. Pharm. Sci., 1977, 66, pp. 1-19.
  • pharmaceutically-acceptable acid addition salt means those salts which retain the biological effectiveness and properties of the free bases and which are not biologically or otherwise undesirable, formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, sulfamic acid, nitric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like, and organic acids such as acetic acid, trifluoroacetic acid, adipic acid, ascorbic acid, aspartic acid, benzenesulfonic acid, benzoic acid, butyric acid, camphoric acid, camphorsulfonic acid, cinnamic acid, citric acid, digluconic acid, ethanesulfonic acid, glutamic acid, glycolic acid, glycerophosphoric acid, hemisulfic acid, hexanoic acid, formic acid, fu aric acid, 2-hydroxyethane- sulfonic acid (isethionic acid), lactic acid, hydroxymaleic acid, malic acid,
  • pharmaceutically-acceptable base addition salt means those salts which retain the biological effectiveness and properties of the free acids and whic are not biologically or otherwise undesirable, formed with inorganic bases such as ammonia or hydroxide, carbonate, or bicarbonate of ammonium or a metal cation such as sodium, potassium, lithium, calcium, magnesium, iron, zinc, copper, manganese, aluminum, and the like. Particularly preferred are the ammonium, potassium, sodium, calcium, and magnesium salts.
  • Salts derived from pharmaceutically- acceptable organic nontoxic bases include salts of primary, secondary, and tertiary amines, quaternary amine compounds, substituted amines including naturally occurring substituted amines, cyclic amines and basic ion-exchange resins, such as methylamine, dimethylamine, trimethylamine, ethylamine, diethylamine, triethylamine, isopropylamine, tripropylamine, tributylamine, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, 2-dimethylaminoethanol, 2-diethylaminoethanol, dicyclohexylamine, lysine, arginine, histidine, caffeine, hydrabamine, choline, betaine, ethylenediamine, glucosamine, methylglucamine, theobromine, purines, piperazine, piperidine, N- ethylpiperidine, tetramethyiammonium compounds, tetraethyl
  • mammal as it is used herein is meant to encompass humans, as well as non-human mammals which are susceptible to infection by hepatitis C virus including domestic animais, such as cows, pigs, horses, dogs and cats, and non- domestic animals.
  • antiviral agent means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the formation and/or replication of a virus in a mammal. This includes agents that interfere with either host or viral mechanisms necessary for the formation and/or replication of a virus in a mammal. Such agents can be selected from: another anti-HCV agent, HIV inhibitor, HAV inhibitor and HBV inhibitor.
  • Antiviral agents include, for example, ribavirin, amantadine, VX-497 (merimepodib, Vertex Pharmaceuticals), VX-498 (Vertex Pharmaceuticals), Levovirin, Viramidine, Ceplene (maxamine), XTL-001 and XTL-002 (XTL Biopharmaceuticals).
  • other anti-HCV agent means those agents that are effective for diminishing or preventing the progression of hepatitis C related symptoms of disease.
  • agents can be selected from: immunomodulatory agents, inhibitors of HCV NS3 protease, inhibitors of HCV polymerase or inhibitors of another target in the HCV life cycle.
  • immunomodulatory agent means those agents (compounds or biologicals) that are effective to enhance or potentiate the immune system response in a mammal.
  • Immunomodulatory agents include, for example, class I interferons (such as ⁇ , ⁇ -, ⁇ - , ⁇ - and ⁇ -interferons, consensus interferons and asialo-interferons), class II interferons (such as ⁇ -interferons) and pegylated forms thereof.
  • inhibitor of HCV NS3 protease means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the function of HCV NS3 protease in a mammal.
  • Inhibitors of HCV NS3 protease include, for example, those compounds described in WO 99/07733, WO 99/07734, WO 00/09558, WO 00/09543, WO 00/59929, WO 03/064416, WO 03/064455, WO 03/064456, WO 02/060926, WO 03/053349, WO 03/099316 or WO 03/099274, and the Vertex pre- development candidate identified as VX-950.
  • inhibitor of HCV polymerase means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the function of an HCV polymerase in a mammal. This includes, for example, inhibitors of HCV NS5B polymerase. Inhibitors of HCV polymerase include non-nucleosides, for example, those compounds described in: • US Application No. 60/441 ,674 filed January 22, 2003, herein incorporated by reference in its entirety (Boehringer Ingelheim), • US Application No.
  • inhibitors of HCV polymerase also include nucleoside analogs, for example, those compounds described in: WO 04/007512 (Merck/lsis), WO 04/003000 (Idenix), WO 04/002999 (Idenix), WO 04/0002422 (Idenix), WO 04/003138 (Merck), WO 03/105770 (Merck), WO 03/105770 (Merck), WO 03/093290 (Genelabs), WO 03/087298 (Biocryst), WO 03/062256 (Ribapharm), WO 03/062255 (Ribapharm), WO 03/061385 (Ribapharm), WO 03/026675 (Idenix), WO 03/026589 (Idenix), WO 03/020222 (Merck), WO 03/000713 (Glaxo), WO 02/100415 (Hoffmann-La Roche), WO 02/1094289 (Hoffmann-
  • inhibitor of another target in the HCV life cycle means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the formation and/or replication of HCV in a mammal other than by inhibiting the function of the HCV NS3 protease. This includes agents that interfere with either host or HCV viral mechanisms necessary for the formation and/or replication of HCV in a mammal.
  • Inhibitors of another target in the HCV life cycle include, for example, agents that inhibit a target selected from helicase, NS2/3 protease and internal ribosome entry site (IRES).
  • Specific examples of inhibitors of another target in the HCV life cycle include ISIS-14803 (ISIS Pharmaceuticals).
  • HIV inhibitor means an agents (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the formation and/or replication of HIV in a mammal. This includes agents that interfere with either host or viral mechanisms necessary for the formation and/or replication of HIV in a mammal. HIV inhibitors include, for example, nucleoside inhibitors, non-nucleoside inhibitors, protease inhibitors, fusion inhibitors and integrase inhibitors.
  • HAV inhibitor means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the formation and/or replication of HAV in a mammal. This includes agents that interfere with either host or viral mechanisms necessary for the formation and/or replication of HAV in a mammal.
  • HAV inhibitors include Hepatitis A vaccines, for example, Havrix ® (GlaxoSmithKline), VAQTA ® (Merck) and Avaxim ® (Aventis Pasteur).
  • HBV inhibitor means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the formation and/or replication of HBV in a mammal. This includes agents that interfere with either host or viral mechanisms necessary for the formation and/or replication of HBV in a mammal.
  • HBV inhibitors include, for example, agents that inhibit HBV viral DNA polymerase or HBV vaccines.
  • HBV inhibitors include Lamivudine (Epivir-HBV ® ), Adefovir Dipivoxil, Entecavir, FTC (Coviracil ® ), DAPD (DXG), L-FMAU (Clevudine ® ), AM365 (Amrad), Ldt (Telbivudine), monoval-LdC (Valtorcitabine), ACH-126,443 (L-Fd4C) (Achiilion), ' MCC478 (Eli Lilly), Racivir (RCV), Fluoro-L and D nucleosides, Robustafiavone, ICN 2001-3 (ICN), Bam 205 (Novelos), XTL-001 (XTL), Imino-Sugars (Nonyl-DNJ) (Synergy), HepBzyme; and immunomodulator products such as: interferon alpha 2b, HE2000 (Hollis-Eden), Theradi
  • Thymosin alpha-1 Zadaxin ®
  • HBV DNA vaccine PowderJect
  • HBV DNA vaccine Jefferon Center
  • HBV antigen OraGen
  • BayHep B ® Bayer
  • Nabi-HB ® Nabi and Anti-hepatitis B (Cangene)
  • HBV vaccine products such as the following: Engerix B, Recombivax HB, GenHevac B, Hepacare, Bio-Hep B, TwinRix, Comvax, Hexavac.
  • class I interferon means an interferon selected from a group of interferons that all bind to receptor type I. This includes both naturally and synthetically produced class I interferons. Examples of class I interferons include ⁇ -; ⁇ -, ⁇ -, ⁇ - and ⁇ -interferons, consensus interferons, asialo-interferons and pegylated forms thereof.
  • class II interferon as used herein means an interferon selected from a group of interferons that all bind to receptor type II. Examples of class II interferons include ⁇ -interferons.
  • ⁇ antiviral agents ribavirin or amantadine
  • ⁇ immunomodulatory agents class I interferons, class II interferons or pegylated forms thereof;
  • ⁇ HCV polymerase inhibitors nucleoside analogs or non-nucleosides
  • ⁇ inhibitor of another target in the HCV life cycle that inhibits a target selected from: NS3 helicase, NS2/3 protease or internal ribosome entry site (IRES);
  • ⁇ HIV inhibitors nucleosidic inhibitors, non-nucleosidic inhibitors, protease inhibitors, fusion inhibitors or integrase inhibitors; or ⁇ HBV inhibitors: agents that inhibit viral DNA polymerase or is an HBV vaccine.
  • combination therapy is contemplated wherein a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, is co-administered with at least one additional agent selected from: an antiviral agent, an immunomodulatory agent, another inhibitor of HCV NS3 protease, an inhibitor of HCV polymerase, an inhibitor of another target in the HCV life cycle, an HIV inhibitor, an HAV inhibitor • and an HBV inhibitor.
  • additional agents may be combined with the compounds of this invention to create a single pharmaceutical dosage form. Alternatively these additional agents may be separately administered to the patient as part of a multiple dosage form, for example, using a kit. Such additional agents may be administered to the patient prior to, concurrently with, or following the administration of a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • treatment means the administration of a compound or composition according to the present invention to alleviate or eliminate symptoms of the hepatitis C disease and/or to reduce viral load in a patient.
  • prevention means the administration of a compound or composition according to the present invention post-exposure of the individual to the virus but before the appearance of symptoms of the disease, and/or prior to the detection of the virus in the blood, to prevent the appearance of symptoms of the disease.
  • B is preferably selected from (C 2 . 8 )alkyl, (C 3-7 )cycloalkyI and (C 1-3 )alkyl- (C 3 . 7 )cycloalkyl, a) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri- substituted with (C t .
  • alkyl, cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di-substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and O-(C 1-4 )alkyl; and c) wherein each of said alkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with fluorine or mono-substituted with chlorine or bromine; and d) wherein in each of said cycloalkyl groups being 5-, 6- or 7-membered, one or two -CH 2 -groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C-atoms.
  • B is selected from ethyl, n-propyl, i-propyl, n-butyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2-methylpropyI, ferf-butyl, cyclopropyl, cycl ⁇ butyl, cyclopentyl and cyclohexyl, a) wherein each of said groups is optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from methyl and ethyl; b) wherein each of said groups is optionally mono- or di-substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy, methoxy and ethoxy; and c) wherein each of said alkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with fluorine or mono-substituted with chlorine or bromine; and d) wherein in each of said cycloalkyl groups being 5-, 6- or 7-membered, one or two -CH 2 -groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced by -O
  • B is even more preferably selected from ethyl, 1-methylethyl, ,1-dimethylethyl, propyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2-methylpropyl, 1,1-dimethylpropyl, 1 ,2-dimethylpropyl, 2,2- dimethylpropyl, 1,1,2-trirnethylpropyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, 1-ethylpropyl, 1 -ethyl-2- methyipropyl, 1-(1-methylethyl)-2-methylpropyl, 1-ethyl-2,2-dimethylpropyl, butyl, 1- methylbutyl, 2-methylbutyl, 3-methylbutyl, 1 ,2-dimethylbutyl, 1, -dimethylbutyl, 1,3- dimethylbutyl, 2,2-dimethylbutyl, 2,3-dimethylbutyl, 3,3-dimethylbutyl, 1,2,2- trimethylbutyl, 1 ,2,3
  • B is cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, or cyclohexyl or is selected from the following formulas, wherein one or two CH 2 - groups of a cycloalkyl group is replaced by oxygen:
  • cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl groups optionally comprising 1 or 2 O-atoms are optionally substituted with 1 , 2 or 3 methyl-groups.
  • cycloalkyl groups, optionally comprising 1 or 2 O-atoms are preferred, wherein the -C-atom is substituted with methyl.
  • B is selected from ethyl, n-propyl, terf-butyl, 2-methylpropyl, 1,2- dimethylpropyl, 1 ,2,2-trimethylpropyl, 2-fluoroethyl, 3-fluoropropyl, 3,3,3- trifluoropropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl and 1 -methylcyclohexyl, and a group selected from:
  • B is selected from ethyl, n-propyl, terf-butyl, cyclopentyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl, 2-fluoroethyl or 3-fluoropropyl.
  • X is O.
  • X is NH
  • R 3 is preferably (C 2-6 )alkyl, (C 3 . 7 )cycloalkyl or (C ⁇ -3 )alkyl-(C 3 . 7 )cycloalkyl, each of which being optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from (C 1- )alkyl.
  • R 3 is more preferably selected from ethyl, propyl, butyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, or cyclohexylmethyl, each of which optionally being substituted with 1 or 2 substituents selected from methyl, ethyl and propyl.
  • R 3 is selected from 1-methylethyl, 1 ,1-dimethyiethyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2-methyl propyl, 1,1-dimethylpropyl, 1,2-dimethylpropyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl, 1- methylcyclohexyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, (l-methylcyclopentyl)methyl and ( -methylcyclohexyl)methyl.
  • R 3 is most preferably selected from 1,1-dimethylethyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl and 1 -methylcyclohexyl.
  • R is most preferably selected from 1,1-dimethylethyl and cyclohexyl.
  • is preferably selected from H, halogen, CH 3 , -OH, -OCH 3 , -OC 2 H 5 , -OC 3 H 7) -OCH(CH 3 ) 2 , -NHCH 3l -NHC 2 H 5 , -NHC 3 H 7 , -NHCH(CH 3 ) 2 , -N(CH 3 ) 2 , -N(CH 3 )C 2 H 5 , N(CH 3 )C 3 H 7 and -N(CH 3 )CH(CH 3 ) 2 .
  • L u is selected from H, -OH, -OCH 3 , halogen and -N(CH 3 ) 2 .
  • is H, -OH or-OCH 3 .
  • is H or -OCH 3 .
  • L 1 and L 2 are preferably each independently selected from: halogen, -CH 3 , -C 2 H 5 , -OCH3, -OC 2 H 5 , -OC 3 H 7 , -OCH(CH 3 ) 2 , CF 3 , -SMe, -SOMe, and SO 2 Me whereby either L 1 or L 2 may be H.
  • L 1 and L 2 are -CH 3 , -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO 2 Me and the other of L 1 and L 2 is H.
  • L 1 is CH 3 , -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO 2 Me and L 2 is H.
  • is selected from: H, -OH and -OCH 3 ; and either one of L 1 and L 2 is CH 3 , -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO 2 Me and the other of L 1 and L 2 is H.
  • is selected from H, -OH and -OCH 3 ;
  • L 1 is - CH 3 , -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO 2 Me; and
  • L 2 is H.
  • is H or -OCH 3 ;
  • L 1 is -CH 3 , Ci or Br; and
  • L 2 is H.
  • this ring system is preferably selected from:
  • X a , X b are independently selected from CH 2) O and NR a ; most preferably O;
  • R a is each independently H or (C 1- )alkyl
  • R is each independently (Chal y!;
  • L 2 is as defined; preferably H or methyl, particularly H.
  • this ring system is preferably selected from:
  • X a , X b are independently selected from CH 2 , O and NR a ; most preferably O;
  • R a is each independently H or (C 1- )alkyl
  • R b is each independently (C 1-4 )alkyl
  • L 1 is as defined; preferably H or methyl, particularly H.
  • L° and L 1 are covalently bonded to form, together with the quinoline residue to Which they are linked, a ring system which is selected from:
  • each R is independently (C 1-4 )alkyl and L 2 is as defined; preferably H or methyl, particularly H. Most preferably, L° and L are covalently bonded to form together with the quinoline residue to which they are linked a ring system selected from
  • L 2 is H or -CH 3 , preferably H
  • R 2 is preferably R 20 , -NHCOR 20 , -NHCOOR 20 , -NHR 21 and -NHCONR 21 R 23 , wherein R 20 is selected from (Chalky!, (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, (C ⁇ . 3 )alkyl-(C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with
  • R 21 is H or R 20 as defined above;
  • R 23 is H or methyl; most preferably H.
  • R 2 is R 20 , NHCOR 20 , -NHCOOR 20 , -NHR 21 -and -NHCONR 21 R 23 , wherein
  • R 20 is selected from methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, /-propyl, n-butyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2- methylpropyl, tert-butyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, 1 ,1-dimethylpropyl, 1,2-dimethylpropyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl- methyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, and cyclohexylmethyl, each of said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl groups being optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from methyl and ethyl, in particular methyl; and
  • R 21 is H or R 20 as defined above; and R 23 is H or methyl; most preferably H.
  • R 2 is selected from: a) amino, ⁇ /-methylamino, ⁇ /-ethy!amino, N-propylamino, ⁇ /-(1-methylethyl)amino, A/-( ,1-dimethylethy[)amino, /V-(2-methylpropyl)amino, ⁇ /-(1-methylpropyl)amino, N-(2,2-dimethyIpropyl)amino, A/-(1,2-dimethylpropyl)amino, ⁇ /-(1,1- dimethylpropyl)amino, ⁇ /-cyclopropylamino, ⁇ /-cyclobuty!amino-, ⁇ /-cyclopentylamino ⁇ , ⁇ /-cyclohexylamino-, ⁇ /-(cyclopropylmethyl)amino, ⁇ /-(cyclobutylmethyl)amino, ⁇ /-(
  • R 2 is -NHCOR 20 , -NHCOOR 20 , or -NHR 21 , wherein R 20 and R 21 are as defined herein.
  • R 20 and R 21 are independently selected from: methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, / ' - propyl, n-butyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2-methylpropyl, fe/f-butyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, 1,1- dimethylpropyl, 1 ,2-dimethylpropyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, each of said cycloalkyl or alkyl-cycloalkyl groups optionally being mono- or di-substituted with methyl or ethyl.
  • R 20 and R 21 are independently selected from: methyl, ethyl, n- propyl, /-propyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, cyclopentyl and cyclopentylmethyl.
  • R 1 is vinyl
  • the asymmetric carbon atoms in the cyclopropyl group take the R,S configuration according to the subformula:
  • R 1 is preferably vinyl.
  • R c is preferably selected from hydroxy or NHSO 2 R s wherein R s is methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, /-propyl, n-butyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2- methylpropyl, ferf-butyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, phenyl, naphthyl, pyridinyl, phenylmethyl (benzyl), naphthylmethyl or pyridinylmethyl; a) each of which optionally being mono-, di- or tri-substituted with substituents selected from fluorine and methyl; and b) each of which optionally being mono- or disubstituted with substituents selected from hydroxy, trifluoromethyl, methoxy and triflu
  • R c is NHSO 2 R s , wherein R s is -N(R N2 )R N1 ), wherein R N1 and R N2 are independently selected from H, (C 1-4 )alkyl, (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, (C ⁇ . 3 )alkyl-
  • (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, (C ⁇ -3 )alkyl-(C 3 . 7 )cycloaIkyl, phenyl and (C 1-3 )alkyl-phenyl are optionally substituted with one, two or three substituents independently selected from halogen, (C ⁇ alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, O-(C ⁇ -6 )alkyl, -NH 2 , -NH(C 1- )alkyl, -N((C 1-4 )alkyl) 2 , -CO-NH 2 , -CO-NH(C )alkyl, -CO-N((C ⁇ )alkyl) 2 , -COOH, and - COO(C 1-6 )alkyl; or
  • R N2 and R N1 are linked, together with the nitrogen to which they are bonded, to form a 5 or 6-membered monocyclic heterocycle which may be saturated or. unsaturated, optionally containing from one to three further heteroatoms independently selected from N, S and O, and optionally substituted with one, two or three substituents independently selected from halogen, (C ⁇ -6 )alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, O-(C 1-6 )alkyl, - .
  • the group R c is hydroxy, NHSO 2 -methyl, NHSO 2 -ethyl, NHSO 2 -(1- methyl)ethyl, NHSO 2 -propyl, NHSO 2 -cyclopropyl, NHSO 2 -CH 2 -cyclopropyl, NHSO 2 - cyclobutyl, NHSO 2 -cyclopentyl, or NHSO 2 -phenyl.
  • R c is hydroxy, or NHSO 2 -cyclopropyl.
  • the group R c is hydroxy. According to an alternative most preferred embodiment, the group R c is NHSO 2 -cyclopropyl. According to another alternative most preferred embodiment, the group R c is NHSO 2 N(CH 3 ) 2 .
  • B is (C ⁇ . 10 )alkyl, (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, or (C 1 ⁇ )alkyl-(C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, a) wherein said cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-
  • alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di- substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and O-(C 1-4 )alkyl; and c) wherein all said alkyl-groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with ' halogen; and d) wherein all said cycloalkyl-groups being 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered having optionally one (for the 4-, 5, 6, or 7-membered) or two (for the 5-, 6- or 7- membered) -CH 2 -groups not directly linked to each other replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C-atoms; X is O or NH;
  • R 3 is (C 2-8 )alkyl, (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl or (C -3 )alkyl-(C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C 1-4 )alkyl;
  • is H, -OH, -O-(C 1-4 )alkyl, -NH 2 , -NH(C ⁇ )alkyl or -N((C 1-4 )alkyl) 2 ;
  • L 1 , L 2 are each independently halogen, (C 1-4 )alkyl, -O-(C 1-4 )alkyl or -S-(C M )alkyl (in any oxidized state such as SO or SO 2 ); and either L or L z (but not both at the same time) may also be H; or
  • L° and L 2 may be covalently bonded to form, together with the two C-atoms to which they are linked, a 5- or 6-membered carbocyclic ring wherein one or two
  • -CH 2 -groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced each independently by -O- or NR a wherein R a is H or (C ⁇ alkyl, and wherein said carbo- or heterocyclic ring is optionally mono- or di-substituted with (C 1-4 )alkyl;
  • R 2 is R 20 , -NR 22 COR 20 , -NR 22 COOR 20 -NR 22 R 21 and -NR 22 CONR 21 R 23 , wherein R 20 is selected from (C 1-a )alkyl, (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl and (C 1- )alkyl- (C 3- )cycloalkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C ⁇ -3 )alkyl; R 2 is H or has one of the meanings, of R 20 as defined above,
  • R 22 and R 23 are independently selected from H and methyl
  • R 1 is ethyl or vinyl
  • R c is hydroxy or NHSO 2 R s wherein R s is (C 1 . 6 )alkyl, (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, (C 1-6 )alkyl- (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, phenyl, naphthyl, pyridinyl, (C 1-4 )alkyl- naphthyl or (C 1-4 )alkyl-pyridinyl; all of which optionally being mono-, di- or tri- substituted with substituents selected from halogen, hydroxy, cyano, (C 1-4 )alkyl, O-(C 1-6 )alkyl, -CO-NH 2 , -CO-NH(C 1-4 )alkyl, -CO-N((C 1-4 )alkyl) 2 , -NH 2 , -NH(C 1-4 )alkyl and -N((Ci -4 )aikyl) 2 ; and all of which
  • B is (C 2-8 )alkyl, (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl or (C 1-3 )alkyl-(C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, a) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri- substituted with (C 1-3 )alkyl; and b) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di- substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and ⁇ -(C t ⁇ alkyl; and c) wherein each of said alkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with fluorine or mono-substituted with chlorine or bromine; and d) wherein in each of said cycloalkyl groups being 5-, 6- or 7-membered, one or two -CH 2 -groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced by -O
  • X ⁇ is O or NH;
  • R 3 is (C 2 . 6 )alkyl or (C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, both of which being optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from
  • is H, -OH, -OCH 3 , halogen or -N(CH 3 ) 2 ;
  • L 1 and L 2 are each independently selected from: halogen, -CH 3 , -C 2 H 5 , -OCH 3 ,
  • L 1 or L 2 may be H;
  • R 2 is R 20 , -NHCOR 20 , -NHCOOR 20 , -NHR 21 and -NHCONR 21 R 23 , wherein
  • R 20 is selected from (C ⁇ alkyl, (C 3- )cycloalkyl, (C ⁇ . 3 )alkyl-(C 3-7 )cycloalkyl, wherein each of said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C 1-3 )alkyl; and
  • R 21 is H or R 20 as defined above;
  • R 23 is H or methyl
  • R 1 is ethyl or vinyl; and R c is hydroxy, NHSO 2 -methyl, NHSO 2 -ethyl, NHSO 2 -(1-methyl)ethyl, NHSO 2 - propyl, NHSO 2 -cyclopropyl, NHSO 2 -CH 2 -cyclopropyl, NHSO 2 -cyclobutyl, NHSO 2 - cyclopentyl or NHSO 2 -phenyl.
  • B is selected from: ethyl, n-propyl, tetf-butyl, 2-methylpropyl, 1 ,2- dimethylpropyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, 2-fluoroethyl, 3-fluoropropyl, 3,3,3- trifluoropropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl and 1 -methylcyclohexyl, and a group selected from:
  • R 3 is selected from 1,1-dimethylethyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl and 1- methylcyclohexyl;
  • is H, -OH or-OCH 3 ;
  • L 1 is CH 3 , -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or
  • R 2 is -NHCOR 20 , -NHCOOR 20 or -NHR 21 , wherein R 20 and R 21 are independently selected from methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, /-propyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, cyclopentyl and cyclopentylmethyl;
  • R 1 is vinyl; and R c is hydroxy or NHSO 2 -cyclopropyl.
  • B is selected from ethyl, n-propyl, .erf-butyl, cyclopentyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl, 2-fluoroethyl and 3-fluoropropyl;
  • R 3 is selected from 1,1- dimethylethyl and cyclohexyl;
  • is H or -OCH 3 ;
  • L is -CH 3 , -Cl, or -Br;
  • L 2 is H; and
  • R c is hydroxy.
  • Examples of preferred embodiments according to this invention is each single compound listed in the following Tables 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6.
  • the pharmaceutical composition of this invention may additionally comprise at least one other anti-HCV agent.
  • anti-HCV agents include, ⁇ - (alpha), ⁇ - (beta), ⁇ - (delta), ⁇ - (gamma), ⁇ - (omega) or ⁇ - (tau) interferon, pegylated -interferon, ribavirin and amantadine.
  • the pharmaceutical composition of this invention may additionally comprise at least one other inhibitor of HCV NS3 protease.
  • the pharmaceutical composition of this invention may additionally comprise at least one inhibitor of HCV polymerase.
  • the pharmaceutical composition of this invention may additionally comprise at least one inhibitor of other targets in the HCV life cycle, including but not limited to, helicase, NS2/3 protease or internal ribosome entry site (IRES).
  • at least one inhibitor of other targets in the HCV life cycle including but not limited to, helicase, NS2/3 protease or internal ribosome entry site (IRES).
  • the pharmaceutical composition of this invention may be administered orally, parenterally or via an implanted reservoir. Oral administration or administration by injection is preferred.
  • the pharmaceutical composition of this invention may contain any conventional non-toxic pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers, adjuvants or vehicles.
  • the pH of the formulation may be adjusted with pharmaceutically acceptable acids, bases or buffers to enhance the stability of the formulated compound or its delivery form.
  • parenteral as used herein includes subcutaneous, intracutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, intra-articular, intrasynovial, intrasternal, intrathecal, and intralesional injection or infusion techniques.
  • the pharmaceutical composition may be in the form of a sterile injectable preparation, for example, as a sterile injectable aqueous or oleaginous suspension.
  • This suspension may be formulated according to techniques known in the art using suitable dispersing or wetting agents (such as, for example Tween 80) and suspending agents.
  • the pharmaceutical composition of this invention may be orally administered in any orally acceptable dosage form including, but not limited to, capsules, tablets, and aqueous suspensions and solutions.
  • carriers which are commonly used include lactose and corn starch.
  • Lubricating agents such as magnesium stearate, are also typically added.
  • useful diluents include lactose and dried corn starch.
  • aqueous suspensions are administered orally, the active ingredient is combined with emulsifying and suspending agents. If desired, certain sweetening and/or flavoring and/or coloring agents may be added.
  • Dosage levels of between about 0.01 and about 100 mg/kg body weight per day, preferably between about 0.1 and about 50 mg/kg body weight per day of the protease inhibitor compound described herein are useful in a monotherapy for the prevention and treatment of HCV mediated disease.
  • the pharmaceutical composition of this invention will be administered from about 1 to about 5 times per day or alternatively, as a continuous infusion. Such administration can be used as a chronic or acute therapy.
  • the amount of active ingredient that may be combined with the carrier materials to produce a single dosage form will vary depending upon the host treated and the particular mode of administration.
  • a typical preparation will contain from about 5% to about 95% active compound (w/w).
  • such preparations contain from about 20% to about 80% active compound.
  • composition of this invention comprises a combination of a compound of formula I and one or more additional therapeutic or prophylactic agent
  • both the compound and the additional agent should be present at dosage levels of between about 10 to 100%, and more preferably between about 10 and 80% of the dosage normally administered in a monotherapy regimen.
  • compositions may be administered in vivo to mammals, such as man, to inhibit HCV NS3 protease or to treat or prevent HCV virus infection. Such treatment may also be achieved using a compound of this invention in combination with another antiviral agent.
  • Preferred other antiviral agents are described within the Definitions section and the section of preferred pharmaceutical compositions according to this invention and include, but are not limited to: ⁇ , ⁇ -, ⁇ -, ⁇ -, ⁇ - or ⁇ - interferon, ribavirin, amantadine; other inhibitors of HCV NS3 protease; inhibitors of HCV polymerase; inhibitors of other targets in the HCV life cycle, which include but are not limited to, helicase, NS2/3 protease, or internal ribosome entry site (IRES); or combinations thereof.
  • the additional agents may be combined with compounds of this invention to create a single dosage form. Alternatively these additional agents may be separately administered to a mammal as part of a multiple dosage form. .
  • another embodiment of this invention provides a method of inhibiting HCV NS3 protease activity in a mammal by administering a compound of the formula I, including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof.
  • this method is useful in decreasing the NS3 protease activity of the hepatitis C virus infecting a mammal.
  • combination therapy is contemplated wherein a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, is co-administered with at least one additional antiviral agent.
  • additional antiviral agents are described hereinbefore and examples of such agents are provided in the Definitions section.
  • These additional agents may be combined with the compounds of this invention to create a single pharmaceutical dosage form. Alternatively these additional agents may be separately administered to the patient as part of a multiple dosage form, for example, using a kit. Such additional agents may be administered to the patient prior to, concurrently with, or following the administration of a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof.
  • a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, set forth herein may also be used as a laboratory reagent.
  • a compound of this invention, including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof may also be used to treat or prevent viral contamination of materials and therefore reduce the risk of viral infection of laboratory or medical personnel or patients who come in contact with such materials (e.g. blood, tissue, surgical instruments and garments, laboratory instruments and garments, and blood collection apparatuses and materials).
  • a compound of formula (I), including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, set forth herein may also be used as a research reagent.
  • a compound of formula (I), including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, may also be used as positive control to validate surrogate cell-based assays or in vitro or in vivo viral replication assays.
  • dipeptide 3 is carried out by coupling the P1 residue to the properly protected .rans-hydroxy proline under standard conditions.
  • the stereochemistry of the hydroxyl group is inverted by the well known Mitsunobu reaction using para-nitrobenzoic acid.
  • Coupling of dipeptide with the P3 moiety yielded tripeptide 6.
  • Introduction of the quinoline moiety to the hydroxyl group of the tripeptide 7 with inversion of stereochemistry can be carried out using either a Mitsunobu reaction or by converting the free hydroxyl group into a good leaving group (such as a brosylate) and displacing it with the hydroxyl quinoline derivative 9.
  • the quinoline used contains a 2-carbomethoxy group as shown in 9. Conversion of the carboxylate group to the aminothiazole derivative is carried out by well known synthetic methodology and is described and exemplified in WO 00/09543 and WO 00/09598. Finally the C-terminal ester is hydrolyzed under basic aqueous conditions.
  • Scheme 2 describes another reaction sequence for making compounds of Formula I.
  • the quinoline moiety is introduced to the dipeptide in a similar way as described in Scheme 1.
  • the P3 moiety is coupled under standard conditions to the dipeptide 21. Conversion of the resulting tripeptide to the final compound is carried out as described in Scheme 1.
  • P1 moieties of compounds of Formula (I) were prepared using the protocols outlined in WO 00/59929, published October 12, 2000, and WO 00/09543, published on February 24, 2000. In particular, reference is made to pages 33-35, Example 1 of WOOO/59929 and Pages 56-69 , Example 9 - 20 of WOOO/09543 for the preparation of 1-aminocyclopropanecarboxylic acid P1 moieties.
  • properly substituted anilines at the 2, 3 and/or 4 position are allowed to react with dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate and the resulting enamine is heated at high , temperatures to effect the cyclization.
  • the corresponding anilines are commercially available or may require some well known chemical transformation.
  • the nitro is commercially available and is then converted to the corresponding amine by using a reducing agent.
  • the carboxylic acid when commercially available, it can be transformed into the corresponding amine via a Curtius rearrangement.
  • the reaction was rendered basic by the addition of 1 N NaOH (25 mL - final pH >10).
  • the solution was washed with EtOAc (2x 200 mL) and the aqueous phase acidified with 1 N HCI (ca. 70 mL - final pH ⁇ 2).
  • the turbid solution was extracted with EtOAc (200 + 150 mL).
  • the extract was dried (MgSO 4 ) and evaporated to give carbamate 4a as a white solid (8.68 g).
  • the reaction mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed with 10% citric acid (2x), water (2x), saturated NaHCO 3 (2x), water (2x) and brine (1x), dried (MgSO 4 ), filtered and evaporated to obtain the crude compound as a nearly colorless oil (3.73 g; >100%; assume 9.89 mmol).
  • the crude product (1.01 g; 2.97 mmol) was dissolved in DMSO (6.5 mL) and cyclopentylamine was added dropwise. The reaction mixture was stirred at R.T. for 45 min and then diluted with EtOAc.
  • the organic phase was washed with 10% citric acid (2x), water (2x), saturated NaHCO 3 (2x), water (2x) and brine (1x), dried (MgSO 4 ), filtered and evaporated to give the crude cyclopentyl urea -Tbg-OBn product as a nearly colorless oil.
  • the crude material was purified by flash column chromatography with silica using hexane:EtOAc 9:1 to remove the less polar impurities and 7:3 to elute the purified product as a thick colorless oil (936 mg; 95%o).
  • the benzyl ester product (936 mg; 2.82 mmol) was deprotected under a hydrogen filled balloon at R.T.
  • the diester A4 (6.5 g, 23.27 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (12 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 350- 400 ° C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 240 ° C (observe MeOH evolution at 230-240 ° C) a count of six minutes was begun before the bath (temperature end point: 262 ° C) was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature. A solid formed upon cooling which was diluted with ether, filtered and dried to give a tan brown solid (3.48 g crude).
  • Step A 2-Amino-3-nitrophenol B1 (5 g; 32.4 mmol) was dissolved in H 2 O (29.5 mL) and 1,4- dioxane (14.7 mL). The mixture was heated to reflux and hydrobromic acid (48%; 16.7 mL; 147 mmol) was added dropwise over a period of 20 min. Upon completion of the addition, the reflux was maintained an additional 15 min. The reaction was cooled to 0 ° C (ice bath), and sodium nitrite (2.23 g; 32.3 mmol) in H 2 O (20 mL) was added over a period of 30 min.
  • Step B The nitrophenol starting material B2 (3.1 g; 14.2 mmol) was dissolved in DMF (20 mL) and to the solution was added ground cesium carbonate (5.58 g; 17.1 mmol) followed by Mel (2.6 mL; 42.5 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. The DMF was evaporated, the residue taken up in ether (1x 200 mL), washed with water (1x 200 mL), brine (4x 00 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ), filtered and evaporated to afford the crude 2-bromo-3-nitroanisole B3 (94%; 3.1 g) as an orange solid.
  • Step A 2-Amino-3-nitrophenol B1 (5 g; 32.4 mmol) was dissolved in concentrated HCl (75 mL) and 1 ,4-dioxane (14.7 mL). The mixture was heated to 70 ° C until most of the solids were in solution. The reaction mixture was cooled to 0 ° C (ice bath), and sodium nitrite (2.23 g; 32.3 mmol) in H 2 O (5.4 mL) was added over a period of 3 hours to the brown solution. The temperature was maintained below 10 ° C during the addition and the stirring was continued for an additional 15 min at 0 ° C.
  • This diazonium intermediate was poured into a solution of Cu(l)CI (3.8 g; 38.9 mmol) in H 2 O (18.5 mL) and cone. HCl (18.5 mL) at 0 ° C. The reaction was stirred for 15 min at 0 ° C, warmed to 60 ° C, and stirred for an additional 15 min The reaction mixture was then brought to room temperature, and left to stir overnight. The reaction mixture was transferred to a separatory funnel and extracted with ether (3X 150 mL). The organic layers were combined, washed with brine (1X), dried (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtered and concentrated to afford the crude product (5.83 g) as a red-brown oil.
  • Step B The nitrophenol starting material C2 (1.3 g; 7.49 mmol) was dissolved in DMF (10 mL) and to this solution was added ground cesium carbonate (2.92 g; 8.96 mmol), followed by Mel (1.4 mL; 22.5 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. The DMF was evaporated in vac ⁇ o and the residue taken up in ether (150 mL), washed with water (150 mL), brine (4x 100 mL), and then dried over (MgSO 4 >. The organic phase was filtered and evaporated to afford the crude 2- chloro-3-nitroanisole 03 (98%; 1.38 g) as an orange solid. Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 93%.
  • Step C 2-Chloro-3-nitroanisole C3 (1.38 g; 7.36 mmol) was dissolved in a mixture of glacial acetic acid (19 mL)/ethanol (19 mL). To this solution was added iron powder (1.64 g; 29.4 mmol). The mixture was stirred at reflux for 3.5 hr and worked up. The reaction mixture was diluted with water (70 mL), neutralized with solid Na 2 CO 3 and the product extracted with CH 2 CI 2 (3X 150 mL).
  • Step B Compound D2 (2.28 g, 9.45 mmol) was treated with 4N HCI/dioxane solution (from Aldrich) (10 mL, 40 mmol) for 60 min and HPLC analysis showed that the starting material was fully consumed.
  • the reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo, re- dissolved in EtOAc and washed with water, saturated NaHCO 3 (aq), and saturated brine.
  • the organic phase was dried (MgSO ), filtered and concentrated to give. 1.18 g (88%) of D3 as a brown oil, which was used as is in the following step.
  • Step C Aniline D3 (1.18 g, 8.36 mmol) was combined with dimethylacetylene dicarboxylate A3 (1.45 mL, 10.0 mmol) in methanol (25 mL). The reaction was refluxed for 2 hours before being concentrated to dryness. The crude material was purified by flash chromatography eluting with 9/1 (hexane/EtOAc) to give the Michael adduct D4 as a yellow oil, (1.27 g, 54%).
  • the Michael adduct D4 was dissolved in warm diphenyl ether (6 mL) and placed in a sand bath previously heated to ⁇ 350°C. The internal temperature of the reaction was monitored and maintained at ⁇ 245°C for about 5 minutes (solution turns brown). After cooling to R.T., the desired 4-hydroxy ' quinoline crashed out of solution. The brown solid was filtered and washed several times with diethyl ether to give, after drying, quinoline D5 as a brown solid (0.51 g, 45%). MS: 252 (M + H) + , 249.9 (M - H)-.
  • Step C Sulfuric acid (18 mL) was added to the solution of aniline E3 (4.20 g, 25.27 mmol) in water (36 mL) at 0°C followed by the addition of sodium nitrite (2.3 g, 33.33 mmol in water (6 mL).
  • sodium nitrite 2.3 g, 33.33 mmol in water (6 mL).
  • This solution was brought to reflux and then the initial solution was added dropwise while maintaining a boil. After the addition was complete, boiling was continued for 5 ' min and the mixture then poured onto ice/sodium carbonate mixture while cooling in an ice bath.
  • the product was extracted with aq. EtOAc and concentrated to yield a dark brown viscous liquid E4 (2.00 g, 47 %) which was employed in subsequent reaction without further purification.
  • MS ES " 210.9.
  • the Michael adduct E7 was dissolved in warm diphenyl ether (10 mL) and placed in a sand bath previously heated to ⁇ 350°C. The, internal temperature of the reaction was monitored, maintained at ⁇ 245°C for about 5 minutes (solution turns brown) and cooled to R.T. at which time the desired 4-hydroxyquinoline precipitated out of solution. The brown solid was filtered and washed several times with diethyl ether to give quinoline E8 as a yellow-brown solid after drying (1.10 g, 88 %).
  • the diester F3 (1.8 g, 6.44 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (5 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 350- 400 ° C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 240 ° C, a count of five minutes was begun before the bath was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature overnight. A solid formed upon cooling which was diluted with ether, filtered and dried to give a brown solid (0.97 g crude) containing both regioisomers in almost equal proportions. The crude material was triturated with MeOH and EtOAc, filtered and dried to provide the correct regioisomer of the methylquinoline product F4 as a yellow solid (245 mg, 15% yield).
  • the Boc starting material G2 (257 mg; 1.08 mmol) was dissolved in 4M HCI/dioxane (5.0 mL) and stirred at room temperature for 1 hr. The solvent was evaporated and the residue diluted with saturated sodium bicarbonate (few mL) and 1 M NaOH (1 mL), extracted with EtOAc (2x), dried (MgSO 4 ), filtered and evaporated to dryness to provide the crude 2,3-methylene dioxyaniline G3 (158 mg; 106%,).
  • the diester G4 (180 mg, 0.645 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (2.5 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 350-400 ° C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 250 ° C (observe MeOH evolution at 220-230°C) a count of six minutes was begun before the bath (temperature end point :262 ° C) was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature. A solid formed upon cooling which was diluted with ether, filtered and dried to give the crude dioxyquinoline G5 (125 mg; 78 %). Purification was not required and the material was used as such in the following reactions. MS (M + H) + ; 246, and (M - H) " ; 248.1. Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm :88%.
  • Triethylamine (5.0 mL, 35.6 mmol) was added to a flask containing the amine H1 (2.0 mL, 17.8 mmol) and dichioromethane (100 mL) under an atmosphere of nitrogen. The contents were cooled in an ice bath and trimethylacetylchloride (3.3 mL, 26.7 mmol) was added dropwise. The reaction was allowed to warm slowly to R.T. and stirred for 14 h. at this temperature. The reaction was quenched with NaHCO 3 saturated solution and extracted with EtOAc. The combined organic layers were dried, filtered and concentrated followed by flash column chromatography (4:1 to 1:1 hexane:EtOAc) to yield the desired product H2 as an off-white solid (3.7 g, 97 % yield).
  • n-BuLi (15.9 mL, 1.6M, 25.5 mmol) was added dropwise to a flame dried flask containing a solution of the starting amide H2 (1.6 g, 7.72 mmol) in THF at 0 ° C under argon. Solution turned slight yellow/orange color when n-BuLi was added. The solution was allowed to warm slowly to R.T. and stirred for 24 h. The solution was again cooled to 0°C and ethylene oxide (0.46 mL, 9.26 mmol) was added dropwise.
  • H4 H5 HCl (4.0 mL, 6.0M) was added to a solution of amide H4 (0.27 g, 1.22 mmol) in MeOH (4.0 mL) at 23 ° C. The reaction was then heated to reflux for 48 h, NaHCO 3 (saturated, aq) was added and was extracted with EtOAc. The combined organic layers were dried, filtered and concentrated to obtain the desired aniline H5 which was of sufficient purity to employ in further transformations.
  • the diester J2 (10.53 g, 37.43 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (35 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 350-400 ° C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 245 ° C, a count of six minutes was begun before the bath was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature. A precipitate formed, which was suspended in ether, filtered and washed again with ether to provide the C8-SMe quinoline product J3 (6.15 g; 66%). MS (M + H) + ; 250 Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 99%.
  • Step 1
  • the diester K5 (1.13 g, 3.52 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (3.0 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 400- 440°C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 230°C (observe MeOH evolution at 220°C) a count of six minutes was begun before the bath (temperature end point : 242°C) was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature.
  • This quinoline moiety was used for the synthesis of compounds 1032 and 1033 of table 1.
  • quinoline K6 was used for the synthesis of compounds 1034, 1035, 1057 and 1058, also of table 1 .
  • Conversion of the C7-fen!-butyl-ether group to an hydroxyl group was done by treatment of the final compound with 50% TFA in dichloromethane for 30 min. at 0°C then for 30 min. at R.T. , evaporated to dryness, diluted with water and lyophilized.
  • the diester L2 (10 g, 37.70 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (15 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 350- 400 ° C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 240 ° C, a count of six minutes was begun before the bath was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature. No solid formed upon cooling, therefore, the crude mixture was flash column purified with hexane : EtOAc (6 : 4 to 5 : 5 to remove impurities, then, 2 : 8 to complete elution) to provide the C8-OMe quinoline product L3 (4.56 g; 52 %). MS (M - H) " ; 231.9 Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 99%.
  • Dipeptide 1 (72.0 g, 203 mmol), triphenylphosphine (63.94 g, 243.8 mmol, 1.2 equiv.) and 4-nitrobenzoic acid (41.08 g, 245.8 mmol, 1.2 equiv) were dissolved in dry THF (1.4 L) The stirred solution was cooled to 0°C under a nitrogen atmosphere. Diethyl azodicarboxylate (38.4 mL, 244 mmol, 1.2 equiv.) was then added dropwise over 45 min and the reaction allowed to warm to R.T. After 4 h, the solvent was evaporated. The residue was divided into four portions.
  • Boc-dipeptide ester 2 was obtained as an amorphous white solid after evaporation of the solvents and drying of the residues under high vacuum at 70°C for 1 h (108.1 g, quantitative).
  • a solution of 4N hydrogen chloride in dioxane was added to the Boc-dipeptide ester 2 (108 g, 243 mmol) resulting in a colorless solution. The solution was stirred at R.T. for 1 h. The solvent was evaporated and the residue placed under high vacuum for 3 h affording the hydrochloride salt of compound 3 as an amorphous solid. The solid was used as such.
  • the tripeptide 6a (15.68 g) was dissolved in THF (200 mL) and water (30 mL) was added. The resulting solution was cooled to 0 ° C and a solution of lithium hydroxide monohydrate (1.18 g, 28.12 mmol) was added over 3 min with vigorous stirring. After 3 h at 0 ° C, the excess base was neutralized with 1 N HCl (final pH ca. 6) and the THF evaporated, resulting in an aqueous suspension (yellow gum). The mixture was extracted with EtOAc (2x 200 mL) and washed with saturated NaHCO 3 (2x 300 mL). The combined extracts were dried over MgSO 4 and evaporated to yield a pale yellow foam. Flash chromatography of the foam over silica gel using EtOAc as eluent afforded 7a as a white amorphous solid (9.77 g, 91%).
  • brosylate 7aBrs 0.5 g; 0.71 mmol
  • bromoquinoline B6 (234 mg; 0.75 mmol)
  • ground cesium carbonate 56 mg; 0.78 mmol
  • the reaction mixture was poured into EtOAc, washed with H 2 O (1X), NaHCO 3 (saturated; 2X), brine (5X), dried, filtered and concentrated to afford the crude product (0.565 g) as an off white solid.
  • Tripeptide 10b (149 mg, 0.210 mmol), in 5 mL of a 1:1 mixture of THF-MeOH, was cooled to ' 0 ° C for the addition of a 1 N NaOH aqueous solution (0.24 mL, 0.240 mmol). The resulting solution was stirred.15 min at 0 ° C, 1.5 h at R.T. and found to be incomplete by analytical HPLC. Additional 1 N NaOH (0.05 mL, 0.05 mmol) was added and the reaction stirred for an additional hour. The mixture was quenched with 1 M HCl, evaporated to near dryness, diluted with water, frozen and lyophilized to provide the acid 11b (crude material used for next step; assume 0.210 mmol). Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06% TFA; CH 3 CN : H 2 O) : 89%. Step 2 : Synthesis of diazoketone 12b:
  • ⁇ -Bromoketone 13b 49 mg, 0.0635 mmol
  • ⁇ /-neopentylthiourea 8a (12 mg; 0.0688 mmol) were dissolved in isopropanol (3 mL) and the yellow solution was heated at 75 ° C for 1 hour. The solution was allowed to cool to R.T. and evaporated to dryness. This crude material 14b was used for next step (assume 0.0635 mmol).
  • M.S.(electrospray) 845.5 (M-H) " 847.5 (M+H) + .
  • Step 2 The conversion of the 2-carbomethoxy group of 10d into the 2-(1-oxo-2-bromo)ethyl group of 13d was done using the reaction sequence described in Example 7, steps 1, 2 and 3.
  • Step 3 The conversion of the 2-carbomethoxy group of 10d into the 2-(1-oxo-2-bromo)ethyl group of 13d was done using the reaction sequence described in Example 7, steps 1, 2 and 3.
  • E11-1 Potassium cyanide (1.43 g, 22.0 mmol) was added to a stirred solution of methylcyclopentanol (2.00 g, 20.0 mmol) in glacial acetic acid (1.00 mL) resulting in a thick slurry. To this was added, dropwise, sulfuric acid (3 mL, caution: exothermic) at a rate at which the temperature was maintained at ca. 30-35°C. Additional acetic acid (1 mL) was added to facilitate stirring of the thick paste. The mixture was then heated to 55-60°C for 30 min followed by stirring at ambient temperature for 16 h.
  • E11-4 The E11-3 (6.80 g, 21.2 mmol) was dissolved in dioxane (4 mL) and a solution of 4N HCl in dioxane (30 mL, 120 mmol) added. After stirring at ambient temperature for 2 h, the solvent was evaporated and the residue allowed to stand under a stream of nitrogen resulting in slow solidification. This material was then triturated with hexane (2x 50 mL), filtered, air dried for 30 min then placed under high vacuum for 5 days to afford the hydrochloride salt as a white solid (4.86 g, 89%).
  • E11-5 To a stirred, ice cold solution of E11-4 (4.85 g, 18.8 mmol) in tetrahydrofuran (75 mL) was added diisopropylethylamine (8.20 mL, 47.0 mmol) followed by the dropwise addition of phenylchloroformate (2.60 mL, 20.7 mmol) under an argon atmosphere. A thick precipitate formed which, upon vigorous stirring, became a fine suspension. After 4.5 h, the mixture was concentrated to.
  • E11-6 To a solution of E11 -5 (1.00 g, 2.93 mmol) in DMSO (2.00 mL) containing acetonitrile (1.00 mL) was added diisopropylethylamine (817 ⁇ L) followed by the amine E11-2 (477 mg, 3.52 mmol). The reaction was stirred at ambient temperature for 2 h and then heated to 70°C for 45 min The solution was then diluted with ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with 5% aq K 2 CO 3 (4x 50 mL) and brine (50 L).
  • E 1-7 To solution of urea E11-6 (780 mg, 2.25 mmol) in absolute ethanol (10 mL) under an argon atmosphere was added 10% Pd-C. catalyst (100 mg). The system was purged three times with H 2 and then stirred vigorously under a hydrogen- balloon. After 3 h, the catalyst was filtered over Celite and the filtrate evaporated. The residue was then dissolved in methanol (ca. 10 mL), filtered through a Millipore Millex 0.45 uM filter and then evaporated to yield the acid E11 -7 as a white solid (539 mg, 93%).
  • E11-8 The urea E11-7 (239 mg, 0.932 mmol) and TBTU (3.06 mg, 0.979 mmol) were dissolved/suspended in anhydrous dichloromethane (4 mL) and diisopropylethylamine (157 ⁇ L, 0.900 mmol) added. The reaction was stirred at ambient temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere until the solution became nearly homogeneous (ca. 5 min).
  • E11-9 The ester E11-8 (645 mg, 0.894 mmol) was dissolved in tetrahydrofuran (16 mL) containing methanol (8 mL) and 1.0N aqueous sodium hydroxide solution (900 mL, 0.900 mmol) then added dropwise with vigorous stirring at ambient temperature. After 5 h, the solution was evaporated (keeping the bath temperature below 30°C) and then placed under high vacuum overnight to afford the carboxylate salt as a pale yellow solid (725 mg, quantitative) which was used without further purification (ca. 10 % of diacid present).
  • E11-1Q To a stirred, ice cold suspension of sodium salt E11-9 (0.894 mmol) in tetrahydrofuran (10 L) under an argon atmosphere was added triethylamine (240 ⁇ L, 1.72 mmol) followed by the dropwise addition of isobutyl chloroformate (174 ⁇ L, .34 mmol). The resulting suspension was stirred at 0 C C for 3 h and a solution of diazomethane in ethyl ether (0.7M, 10 mL, 7 mmol) then added. The yellow suspension was stirred for 30 min at 0°C and then allowed to warm to ambient temperature. After 1 h, nitrogen was bubbled through the suspension for 5 min.
  • E11-12 To a solution of bromoketone E11-11 (75 mg, 0.10 mmol) in isopropanol (0.30 mL) was added diisopropylethylamine (87 ⁇ L, 0.50 mmol) and N- acetylthiourea (18 mg, 0.15 mmol). The stirred mixture was heated to 70°C for 1 h and then extracted with ethyl acetate (30 mL) and washed with 5% aqueous
  • tripeptide ester E13-2 The urea-P3 acid was coupled with the P1-P2 fragment 15b as described in Example 11.
  • E14-2 The urea-P3 acid E14-2 was prepared from E11-5 and amine E14-1 by the same sequence of reactions as described in Example 11.
  • E14-3 The urea-P3 acid was coupled with the P1-P2 fragment 15b as described in Example 11.
  • the final inhibitor was prepared from E14-3 by a sequence of steps identical to that described on Example 11.
  • the product of the final saponification was isolated as an amorphous yellow powder (trifluoroacetate salt, 10 mg, 21 %).
  • a series of 8-mL vials were disposed in a reaction block from an ACT496 synthesizer (from Advanced Chemtech).
  • ACT496 synthesizer from Advanced Chemtech
  • each vial was added the thio-derivative (8) of interest (0.0688 mmole), the bromoketone (0.0625 mmole) and isopropanol (500 ⁇ L).
  • the closed vials were heated at 70°C for 1 h.
  • the solvent was then evaporated using a vacuum centrifuge (SpeedVac) and was co-evaporated with 1 ,2- dichloroethane.
  • the crude products were dried under high vacuum overnight.
  • HATU (20 mg, 0.05 mmol) was added to a solution of compound 17A1 (Compound 3004, Table 3; 20 mg, 0.03 mmol) and DIPEA (0.03 mL, 0.16 mmol) in DMF (1.5 mL) at RT.
  • the solution was stirred for 1h followed by the addition of DMAP (16 mg, 0.13 mmol) and cyclopropanesulfonamide (7.0 mg, 0.06 mmol). After addition was complete, the mixture was allowed to stir for 15 min and DBU (0.02 mL, 0.14 mmol) was added dropwise.
  • Example 17A Using the procedure of Example 17A but starting with compound 17B1 (Compound 6016, Table 6), compound 17B2 (Compound 7002, Table 7) was prepared as a light yellow solid (5.4 mg, 16% yield).
  • Huh7 cells that stably maintain a subgenomic HCV replicon were established as previously described (Lohman et al., 1999. Science 285: 110-113) and designated as the S22.3 cell-line.
  • S22.3 cells are maintained in Dulbecco's Modified Earle Medium (DMEM) supplemented with 10% FBS and 1 mg/mL neomycin (Standard Medium). During the assay, DMEM medium supplemented with 10% FBS, containing 0.5% DMSO and lacking neomycin was used (Assay Medium). 16 hours prior to compound addition, S22.3 cells are trypsinized and diluted to 50 000 cells/mL in Standard Medium. 200 ⁇ L (10 000 cells) are distributed into each well of a 96-well plate. The plate was then incubated at 37°C with 5% CO 2 until the next day.
  • test compound 10 ⁇ L was added to 2 mL of Assay Medium for a final DMSO concentration of 0.5% and the solution was sonicated for 15 min and filtered through a 0.22 ⁇ M Millipore Filter Unit. 900 ⁇ L was transferred into row A of a Polypropylene Deep-Well Titer Plate. Rows B to H contain 400 ⁇ L aliquots of Assay Medium (containing 0.5% DMSO), and are used to prepare serial dilutions (1/2) by transferring 400 ⁇ L from row to row (no compound was included in row H).
  • Cell culture medium was aspirated from the 96-well plate containing the S22.3 cells. 175 ⁇ L of assay medium with the appropriate dilution of test compound was transferred from each well of the compound plate to the corresponding well of the cell culture plate (row H was used as the "No inhibition control"). The cell culture plate was incubated at 37°C with 5% CO 2 for 72 h.
  • RNeasy 96 plate was sealed with tape and the Square-Well Block with the RNeasy 96 plate was loaded into the holder and placed in a rotor bucket of a 4K15C centrifuge. The sample was centrifuged at 6000 rpm (-5600 x g) for 4 min at room temperature. The tape was removed from the plate and 0.8 mL of Buffer RW1 (Qiagen® RNeasy 96 kit) was added to each well of the RNeasy 96 plate. The RNeasy 96 plate was sealed with a new piece of tape and centrifuged at 6000 rpm for 4 min at room temperature.
  • the RNeasy 96 plate was placed on top of another clean Square-Well Block, the tape removed and 0.8 mL of Buffer RPE (Qiagen® RNeasy 96 kit) was added to each well of the RNeasy 96 plate.
  • the RNeasy 96 plate was sealed with a new piece of tape and centrifuged at 6000 rpm for 4 min at room temperature.
  • the tape was removed and another 0.8 mL of Buffer RPE (Qiagen® RNeasy 96 kit) was added to each well of the RNeasy 96 plate.
  • the RNeasy 96 plate was sealed with a new piece of tape and centrifuged at 6000 rpm for 10 min at room temperature.
  • RNA was quantified on the STORM® system (Molecular Dynamics®) using the RiboGreen® RNA Quantification Kit (Molecular Probes®). Briefly, the RiboGreen reagent was diluted 200-fold in TE (10 mM Tris-HCI pH 7.5, 1 mM EDTA). Generally, 50 ⁇ L of reagent was diluted in 10 mL TE. A Standard Curve of ribosomal RNA was diluted in TE to 2 ⁇ g/mL and pre-determined amounts (100, 50, 40, 20, 10, 5, 2 and 0 ⁇ L) of the ribosomal RNA solution are then transferred in a new 96- well plate (COSTAR # 3997) and the volume was completed to 100 ⁇ L with TE.
  • column 1 of the 96-well plate was used for the standard curve and the other wells are used for the RNA samples to be quantified.
  • 10 ⁇ L of each RNA sample that was to be quantified was transferred to the corresponding well of the 96-well plate and 90 ⁇ L of TE was added.
  • One volume (100 ⁇ L) of diluted RiboGreen reagent was added to each well of the 96-well plate and incubated for 2 to 5 minutes at room temperature, protected from light (a 10 ⁇ L RNA sample in a 200 ⁇ L final volume generates a 20X dilution).
  • the fluorescence intensity of each well was measured on the STORM® system (Molecular Dynamics®).
  • a standard curve was created on the basis of the known quantities of the ribosomal RNA and the resulting fluorescent intensities.
  • the RNA concentration in the experimental samples was determined from the standard curve and corrected for the 20X dilution.
  • R.T.-PCR was optimized for the quantification of the 5' IRES of HCV RNA by using the Taqman technology (Roche Molecular Diagnostics Systems) similar to the technique previously described (Martell et al., 1999. J. Clin. Microbiol. 37: 327-332).
  • the system exploits the 5'-3' nucleolytic activity of AmpliTaq DNA polymerase. Briefly, the method utilizes a dual-labeled fluorogenic hybridization probe (PUTR Probe) that specifically anneals to the template between the PCR primers (primers 8125 and 7028).
  • PUTR Probe dual-labeled fluorogenic hybridization probe
  • the 5' end of the probe contains a fluorescent reporter (6-carboxyfluorescein [FAM]) and the 3' end contains a fluorescent quencher (6-carboxytetramethylrhodamine [TAMRA]).
  • FAM reporter's emission spectrum was suppressed by the quencher on the intact hybridization probe. Nuclease degradation of the hybridization probe releases the reporter, resulting in an increase in fluorescence emission.
  • the ABI Prism 7700 sequence detector measures the increase in fluorescence emission continuously during the PCR amplification such that the amplified product was directly proportion to the signal. The amplification plot was analysed early in the reaction at a point that represents the logarithmic phase of product accumulation.
  • C ⁇ A point representing a defined detection threshold of the increase inthe fluorescent signal associated with the exponential growth of the PCR product for the sequence detector was defined as the cycle threshold (C ⁇ ).
  • C r values are inversely proportional to the quantity of input HCV RNA; such that under identical PCR conditions, the larger the starting concentration of HCV RNA, the lower the C ⁇ .
  • a standard curve was created automatically by the ABI Prism 7700 detection system by plotting the C ⁇ against each standard dilution of known HCV RNA concentration.
  • the Real-Time R.T.-PCR reaction was set-up for the experimental samples that were purified on RNeasy 96 -well plates by combining 5 ⁇ L of each total cellular RNA sample with 45 ⁇ L of Reagent Mix.
  • Those primers amplify a region of 256-nt present within the 5' untranslated region of HCV.
  • NTC No Template Controls
  • RNA copy number was normalized (based on the RiboGreen RNA quantification of the total RNA extracted from the cell culture well) and expressed as genome equivalents / ⁇ g of total RNA [g.e./ ⁇ g].
  • RNA copy number [g.e./ ⁇ g] from each well of the cell culture plate was a measure of the amount of replicating HCV RNA in the presence of various concentrations of inhibitor.
  • the % inhibition was calculated with the following equation:
  • the compounds of this invention are evaluated in the preceding enzymatic and cell based assays, the compounds are found to be highly active.
  • the compounds of formula 1 were found to be selective in that they do not show significant inhibition (no measurable activity at concentrations up to 30 ⁇ M) in the Human Leukocyte Elastase and Cathepsin B assays.
  • the present invention comprises compounds that show pharmacokinetic properties such as detectable plasma levels in the rat at 1 hour and 2 h after an oral dose of 5 mg/kg.
  • an in vivo oral absorption screen is used to determine plasma levels of test compounds in a rat after oral administration:
  • Each "cassette” contains 3-4 compounds at 5 or 4 mg/kg for each compound.
  • the cassettes were prepared as an oral suspension in 0.5% aqueous methylcellulose and 0.3%) of polyoxyethylene (20) sorbitan monooleate (Tween-80).
  • the dosing volume was 10 mL/kg via oral gavage.
  • Plasma samples at 1 and 2 h, blank plasma, blank plasma spiked with all the compounds at 0.5 ⁇ M of each, are extracted by the solid phase extraction method. Samples were analyzed by HPLC and HPLC/MS for comparison purpose. Plasma concentrations are estimated based on the single concentration of 0.5 ⁇ M standard.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Gastroenterology & Hepatology (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • Biophysics (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Communicable Diseases (AREA)
  • Oncology (AREA)
  • Virology (AREA)
  • Zoology (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)
  • Peptides Or Proteins (AREA)
  • Acyclic And Carbocyclic Compounds In Medicinal Compositions (AREA)
  • Nitrogen Condensed Heterocyclic Rings (AREA)

Abstract

Compounds of formula (I): wherein B, X, R3, L0, L1, L2, R2, R1 and RC are defined herein. The compounds are useful as inhibitors of HCV NS3 protease for the treatment of hepatitis C viral infection.

Description

HEPATITIS C INHIBITOR COMPOUNDS
FIELD OF THE INVENTION
The present invention relates to compounds, processes for their synthesis, compositions and methods for the treatment of hepatitis C virus (HCV) infection. In particular, the present invention provides novel peptide analogs, pharmaceutical compositions containing such analogs and methods for using these analogs in the treatment of HCV infection.
BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
Hepatitis C virus (HCV) is the major etiological agent of post-transfusion and community-acquired non-A non-B hepatitis worldwide. It is estimated that over 200 million people worldwide are infected by the virus. A high percentage of carriers become chronically infected and many progress to chronic liver disease, so-called chronic hepatitis C. This group is in turn at high risk for serious liver disease such as liver cirrhosis, hepatocellular carcinoma and terminal liver disease leading to death.
The mechanism by which HCV establishes viral persistence and causes a high rate of chronic liver disease has not been thoroughly elucidated. It is not known how HCV interacts with and evades the host immune system. In addition, the roles of cellular and humoral immune responses in protection against HCV infection and disease have yet to be established. Immunoglobulins have been reported for prophylaxis of transfusion-associated viral hepatitis, however, the Center for Disease Control does not presently recommend immunoglobulin treatment for this purpose. The lack of an effective protective immune response is hampering the development of a vaccine or adequate post-exposure prophylaxis measures, so in the near-term, hopes are firmly pinned on antiviral interventions.
Various clinical studies have been conducted with the goal of identifying pharmaceutical agents capable of effectively treating HCV infection in patients afflicted with chronic hepatitis C. These studies have involved the use of interferon- alpha, alone and in combination with other antiviral agents. Such studies have shown that a substantial number of the participants do not respond to these therapies, and of those that do respond favorably, a large proportion were found to relapse after termination of treatment.
Until recently, interferon (IFN) was the only available therapy of proven benefit approved in the clinic for patients with chronic hepatitis C. However the sustained response rate is low, and interferon treatment also induces severe side-effects (i.e. retinopathy, thyroiditis, acute pancreatitis, depression) that diminish the quality of life of treated patients. Recently, interferon in combination with ribavirin has been approved for patients non-responsive to IFN alone. However, the side effects caused by IFN are not alleviated with this combination therapy. Pegylated forms of interferons such as PEG-lntron® and Pegasys® can apparently partially address these deleterious side-effects but antiviral drugs still remain the avenue of choice for oral treatment of HCV.
Therefore, a need exists for the development of effective antiviral agents for treatment of HCV infection that overcome the limitations of existing pharmaceutical therapies.
HCV is an enveloped positive strand RNA virus in the Flaviviridae family. The single strand HCV RNA genome is approximately 9500 nucleotides in length and has a single open reading frame (ORF) encoding a single large polyprotein of about 3000 amino acids. In infected cells, this polyprotein is cleaved at multiple sites by cellular and viral proteases to produce the structural and non-structural (NS) proteins. In the case of HCV, the generation of mature nonstructural proteins (NS2, NS3, NS4A, NS4B, NS5A, and NS5B) is effected by two viral proteases. The first one, as yet poorly characterized, cleaves at the NS2-NS3 junction (henceforth referred to as NS2/3 protease); the second one is a serine protease contained within the N- terminal region of NS3 (NS3 protease) and mediates all the subsequent cleavages downstream of NS3, both in cis, at the NS3-NS4A cleavage site, and in trans, for the remaining NS4A-NS4B, NS4B-NS5A, NS5A-NS5B sites. The NS4A protein appears to serve multiple functions, acting as a cofactor for the NS3 protease and possibly assisting in the membrane localization of NS3 and other viral replicase components. The complex formation of the NS3 protease with NS4A seems necessary to the processing events, enhancing the proteolytic efficiency at all of the sites. The NS3 protein also exhibits nucleoside triphosphatase and RNA helicase activities. NS5B is a RNA-dependent RNA polymerase that is involved in the replication of HCV.
A general strategy for the development of antiviral agents is to inactivate virally encoded enzymes that are essential for the replication of the virus.
More recently, the NS3 protease has been found to potentially have an additional impact by blocking the IFN-mediated cellular antiviral activity in the infected cell (Foy et al, Science, 17 April 2003). This lends credence to a hypothesis that the
NS3/NS4A protease may represent a dual therapeutic target, the inhibition of which may both block viral replication and restore interferon response of HCV infected cells.
In WO 00/09543, compounds of the formula
Figure imgf000004_0001
wherein a preferred meaning of R2 is an unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted quinolinyl residue as defined therein, are described as hepatitis C viral NS3 protease inhibitors, an enzyme essential for the replication of the hepatitis C virus.
The present invention provides tripeptide compounds that have improved potency against the HCV NS3 protease. Furthermore, compounds being highly active in cell culture are provided.
An advantage of one aspect of the present invention resides in the fact that compounds according to this invention specifically inhibit the NS3 protease and do not show significant inhibitory activity against other human serine proteases such as human leukocyte elastase (HLE), or cysteine proteases such as human liver cathepsin B (Cat B). Compared to the compounds as disclosed in WO 00/09543, compounds as provided by this invention exhibit unexpected advantages. In general they show one or more of the following advantages:
- lower IC50 values in a NS3-NS4A protease assay; - lower EC50 values in a cell based HCV RNA replication assay;
- better solubility; and/or
- higher plasma levels when administered orally in the rat.
SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION Included in the scope of the invention is a racemate, diastereoisomer, or optical isomer of a compound of formula (I):
Figure imgf000005_0001
wherein
. B is (Cι.ιo)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl, or (C1-4)alkyl-(C - )cycloalkyl, a) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri- substituted with (Cι.3)alkyl; and b) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di- substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and ©-(C^alkyl; and c) wherein each of said alkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with halogen; and d) wherein each of said cycloalkyl groups being 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered having optionally one (for the 4-, 5, 6, or 7-membered) or two (for the 5-, 6- or 7-membered) -CH2-groups not directly linked to each other replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C- atoms;
X is O or NH; R3 is (C2-8)alkyl, (C3.7)cycloalkyl or (C1-3)alkyl-(C3.7)cycloalkyl, wherein each of said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri- substituted with (C1-4)alkyl;
L° is H, halogen, (C1-4)alkyl, -OH, -O-(C1-4)alkyl, -NH2, -NH(C1-4)alkyl or -N((C1-4)alkyl)2;
L1, L2 are each independently halogen, cyano, (C1- )alkyl,
Figure imgf000006_0001
-S-(C1^)alkyl, -SO-(Cι-4)alkyl, or-SO2-(C1-4)alkyl, wherein each of said alkyl groups is optionally substituted with from one to three halogen atoms; and either 1 or L2 (but not both at the same time) may also be H; or
L° and L1 or L° and 2 may be covalently bonded to form, together with the two C-atoms to which they are linked, a 5- or 6-membered carbocyclic ring wherein one or two -CH2-groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced each independently by -O- or NRa wherein Ra is H or (C1-4)alkyl, and wherein said carbo- or heterocyclic ring is optionally mono- or di-substituted with (C1-4)aikyl;
R2 is R20, -NR22COR20, -NR22COOR20 -NR22R21 and -NR22CONR21R23, wherein R20 is selected from (C .a)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl and (C1- )alkyl- (C3-7)cycloaIkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (Cι_3)alkyl;
R21 is H or R20 as defined above, R22 and R23 are independently selected from H and methyl,
R1 is ethyl or vinyl;
Rc is hydroxy or NHSO2Rs wherein Rs is (Cι-6)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl, (Cι.6)alkyl- (C3-7)cycloaIkyl, phenyl, naphthyl, pyridinyl, (C1-4)alkyl-phenyl, (C1-4)alkyl- naphthyl or (C -4)alkyl-pyridinyl; each of which optionally being mono-, di- or tri-substituted with substituents selected from halogen, hydroxy, cyano, (C1-4)alkyl, O-(C1.6)alkyl, -CO-NH2, -CO-NH(C1-4)alkyl, -CO-N^d^alkyl);,, -NH2, -NH(C1-4)alkyl and -N((C1-4)alkyl)2, wherein (C1-4)alkyl and O-(Cι-6)alkyl are optionally substituted with one to three halogen atoms; and each of which optionally being monosubstituted with nitro; or Rs is -N(RN2)RN1), wherein RN1 and RN2 are independently selected from
H, (C1-6)alkyl, (C3.7)cycloalkyl, (Cι.6)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, aryl and (C1-6)alkyl-' aryl; wherein said (C1-6)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl, (C1-6)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, aryl and (Cι-6)alkyl-aryl are optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from halogen, (C1-6)alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, O-(C1-6)alkyl, -NH2, -NH(C1-4)alkyl, -N((C )alkyl)2, -CO-NH2,
-CO-NH(C1-4)alkyl,
Figure imgf000007_0001
-COOH, and -COO(C1.6)alkyl; or RN2 and RN1 are linked, together with the nitrogen to which they are bonded, to form a 3- to 7-membered monocyclic saturated or unsaturated heterocycle or a 9- or 10-membered bicyclic saturated or unsaturated heterocycle, each of which optionally containing from one to three further heteroatoms independently selected from N, S and O, and each of which being optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from halogen, (C1-6)alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, ©-(d^alkyl, -NH2, -NH(C1-4)alkyl,
Figure imgf000007_0002
-CO-NH2) -CO-NH(C1-4)alkyl, -CO-N((Cι-4)alkyl)2, -COOH, and -COO(C1-6)alkyl;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof.
Included within the scope of this invention is a pharmaceutical composition comprising an anti-hepatitis C virally effective amount of a compound of formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, in admixture with at least one pharmaceutically acceptable carrier medium or auxiliary agent.
According to a further aspect of this embodiment the pharmaceutical composition according to this invention further comprises a therapeuticaily effective amount of at least one other antiviral agent.
Another important aspect of the invention involves a method of treating or preventing a hepatitis C viral infection in a mammal by administering to the mammal an anti-hepatitis C virally effective amount of a compound of formula I, a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, or a composition as described above, alone or in combination with at least one other antiviral agent, administered together or separately.
Also within the scope of this invention is the use of a compound of formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, as described herein, for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of hepatitis C viral infection in mammal.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF PREFERRED EMBODIMENTS Definitions
As used herein, the following definitions apply unless otherwise noted: With reference to the instances where (R) or (S) is used to designate the absolute configuration of a substituent or asymmetric center of a compound of formula I, the designation is done in the context of the whole compound and not in the context of the substituent or asymmetric center alone.
The designation "P1 , P2, and P3" as used herein refer to the position of the amino acid residues starting from the C-ferminus end of the peptide analogs and extending towards the N-terminus (i.e. P1 refers to position 1 from the C-terminus, P2: second position from the C-terminus, etc.) (see Berger A. & Schechter I., Transactions of the Royal Society London series B257. 249-264 (1970)).
As used herein the term "(1 R, 2S)-vinyl-ACCA" refers to a compound of formula:
Figure imgf000008_0001
namely, (1R, 2S) 1-amino-2-ethenylcyclopropanecarboxylic acid.
The term "(C1.n)alkyl" as used herein, either alone or in combination with another substituent, means acyclic, straight or branched chain alkyl substituents containing from 1 to n carbon atoms. "(Cι-6)alkyr includes, but is not limited to, methyl, ethyl, n- propyl, n-butyl, 1-methylethyl (i-propyl), 1-methylpropyl, 2-methylpropyl,.1,1- dimethylethyl (te/f-butyl), pentyl and hexyl. The abbreviations Me and Pr denote a methyl group and n-propyl respectively.
The term "(C3-7)cycloalky.r as used herein, either alone or in combination with another substituent, means a cycloalkyl substituent containing from 3 to 7 carbon atoms and includes, but is not limited to, cyclopropyl, cyciobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl and cycloheptyl.
The term "(Cι-n)alkyl-(C3.7)cycloalkyl" as used herein means an alkylene radical containing 1 to n carbon atoms to which a cycloalkyl radical containing from 3 to 7 carbon atoms is directly linked;and includes, but is not limited to, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, 1-cyclopentylethyl, 2-cyclopentylethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, 1-cyclohexylethyl, 2-cyclohexylethyl and cycloheptylpropyl.
The term aryl or "C6 or C10 aryl" as used herein interchangeably, either alone or in combination with another radical, means either an aromatic monocyclic group containing 6 carbon atoms or an aromatic bicyclic group containing 10 carbon atoms. Aryl includes, but is not limited to, phenyl, 1 -naphthyl or 2-naphthyl.
As used herein, the term "(Cι-n)alkyl-aryl" means an alkyl radical containing from 1 to n carbon atoms to which an aryl is bonded. Examples of (C1-3)alkyl-aryl include, but are not limited to, benzyl (phenylmethyl), 1-phenylethyl, 2-phenylethyl and phenylpropyl.
The term O-(Cι-n)alkyl" or "(C1-n)alkoxy" as used herein, either alone or in combination with another radical, means the radical -O-(Cι-n)alky! wherein alkyl is as defined above containing from 1 to n carbon atoms, and includes methoxy, ethoxy, propoxy, 1-methylethoxy, butoxy and 1,1-dimethylethoxy. The latter radical is known commonly as terf-butoxy.
The term "halo" or "halogen" as used herein means a halogen substituent selected from fluoro, chloro, bromo or iodo. The term "pharmaceutically acceptable ester" as used herein, either alone or in combination with another substituent, means esters of the compound of formula I in which any of the carboxyl functions of the molecule, but preferably the carboxy terminus, is replaced by an alkoxycarbonyl function:
Figure imgf000010_0001
in which the R moiety of the ester is selected from alkyl (including, but not limited to,, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, t-butyl, n-butyl); alkoxyalkyl (including, but not limited to methoxymethyl); alkoxyacyl (including, but not limited to acetoxymethyl); alkyl-aryl (including, but not limited to benzyl); aryloxyalkyl (including, but not limited to phenoxymethyl); aryl (including, but not limited to phenyl), optionally substituted with halogen, (Cι-4)alkyl or (C1- )alkoxy. Other suitable prodrug esters can be found in Design of prodrugs, Bundgaard, H. Ed. Elsevier (1985). Such pharmaceutically acceptable esters are usually hydrolyzed in vivo when injected in a mammal and transformed into the acid form of the compound of formula I. With regard to the esters described above, unless otherwise specified, any alkyl moiety present advantageously contains 1 to 16 carbon atoms, particularly 1 to 6 carbon atoms. Any aryl moiety present in such esters advantageously comprises a phenyl group. In particular the esters may be a C1-16 alkyl ester, an unsubstituted benzyl ester or a benzyl ester substituted with at least one halogen, C1-6 alkyl, C1-6 alkoxy, nitro or trifluoromethyl.
The term "pharmaceutically acceptable salt" means a salt of a compound of formula (I) which is, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of humans and lower animals without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response, and the like, commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio, generally water or oil-soluble or dispersible, and effective for their intended use. The term includes pharmaceutically-acceptable acid addition salts and pharmaceutically-acceptable base addition salts. Lists of suitable salts are found in, e.g., S.M. Birge et al., J. Pharm. Sci., 1977, 66, pp. 1-19.
The term "pharmaceutically-acceptable acid addition salt" means those salts which retain the biological effectiveness and properties of the free bases and which are not biologically or otherwise undesirable, formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, sulfamic acid, nitric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like, and organic acids such as acetic acid, trifluoroacetic acid, adipic acid, ascorbic acid, aspartic acid, benzenesulfonic acid, benzoic acid, butyric acid, camphoric acid, camphorsulfonic acid, cinnamic acid, citric acid, digluconic acid, ethanesulfonic acid, glutamic acid, glycolic acid, glycerophosphoric acid, hemisulfic acid, hexanoic acid, formic acid, fu aric acid, 2-hydroxyethane- sulfonic acid (isethionic acid), lactic acid, hydroxymaleic acid, malic acid, malonic acid, andelic acid, mesitylenesulfonic acid, methanesulfonic acid, naphthalenesulfonic acid, nicotinic acid, 2-naphthalenesulfonic acid, oxalic acid, pamoic acid, pectinic acid, phenylacetic acid, 3-phenylpropionic acid, pivalic acid, propionic acid, pyruvic acid, salicylic acid, stearic acid, succinic acid, sulfanilic acid, tartaric acid, p-toluenesulfonic acid, undecanoic acid, and the like.
The term "pharmaceutically-acceptable base addition salt" means those salts which retain the biological effectiveness and properties of the free acids and whic are not biologically or otherwise undesirable, formed with inorganic bases such as ammonia or hydroxide, carbonate, or bicarbonate of ammonium or a metal cation such as sodium, potassium, lithium, calcium, magnesium, iron, zinc, copper, manganese, aluminum, and the like. Particularly preferred are the ammonium, potassium, sodium, calcium, and magnesium salts. Salts derived from pharmaceutically- acceptable organic nontoxic bases include salts of primary, secondary, and tertiary amines, quaternary amine compounds, substituted amines including naturally occurring substituted amines, cyclic amines and basic ion-exchange resins, such as methylamine, dimethylamine, trimethylamine, ethylamine, diethylamine, triethylamine, isopropylamine, tripropylamine, tributylamine, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, 2-dimethylaminoethanol, 2-diethylaminoethanol, dicyclohexylamine, lysine, arginine, histidine, caffeine, hydrabamine, choline, betaine, ethylenediamine, glucosamine, methylglucamine, theobromine, purines, piperazine, piperidine, N- ethylpiperidine, tetramethyiammonium compounds, tetraethylammonium compounds, pyridine, N,N-dimethylaniline, N-methylpiperidine, N-methylmorpholine, dicyclohexylamine, dibenzylamine, N,N-dibenzylphenethylamine, 1-ephenamine, N,N'-dibenzyIethylenediamine, polyamine resins, and the like. Particularly preferred organic nontoxic bases are isopropylamine, diethylamine, ethanolamine, trimethylamine, dicyclohexylamine, choline, and caffeine.
The term "mammal" as it is used herein is meant to encompass humans, as well as non-human mammals which are susceptible to infection by hepatitis C virus including domestic animais, such as cows, pigs, horses, dogs and cats, and non- domestic animals.
The term "antiviral agent" as used herein means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the formation and/or replication of a virus in a mammal. This includes agents that interfere with either host or viral mechanisms necessary for the formation and/or replication of a virus in a mammal. Such agents can be selected from: another anti-HCV agent, HIV inhibitor, HAV inhibitor and HBV inhibitor. Antiviral agents include, for example, ribavirin, amantadine, VX-497 (merimepodib, Vertex Pharmaceuticals), VX-498 (Vertex Pharmaceuticals), Levovirin, Viramidine, Ceplene (maxamine), XTL-001 and XTL-002 (XTL Biopharmaceuticals).
The term "other anti-HCV agent" as used herein means those agents that are effective for diminishing or preventing the progression of hepatitis C related symptoms of disease. Such agents can be selected from: immunomodulatory agents, inhibitors of HCV NS3 protease, inhibitors of HCV polymerase or inhibitors of another target in the HCV life cycle.
The term "immunomodulatory agent" as used herein means those agents (compounds or biologicals) that are effective to enhance or potentiate the immune system response in a mammal. Immunomodulatory agents include, for example, class I interferons (such as α~, β-, δ- ,ω- and τ-interferons, consensus interferons and asialo-interferons), class II interferons (such as γ-interferons) and pegylated forms thereof.
The term "inhibitor of HCV NS3 protease" as used herein means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the function of HCV NS3 protease in a mammal. Inhibitors of HCV NS3 protease include, for example, those compounds described in WO 99/07733, WO 99/07734, WO 00/09558, WO 00/09543, WO 00/59929, WO 03/064416, WO 03/064455, WO 03/064456, WO 02/060926, WO 03/053349, WO 03/099316 or WO 03/099274, and the Vertex pre- development candidate identified as VX-950.
The term "inhibitor of HCV polymerase" as used herein means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the function of an HCV polymerase in a mammal. This includes, for example, inhibitors of HCV NS5B polymerase. Inhibitors of HCV polymerase include non-nucleosides, for example, those compounds described in: • US Application No. 60/441 ,674 filed January 22, 2003, herein incorporated by reference in its entirety (Boehringer Ingelheim), • US Application No. 60/441 ,871 filed January 22, 2003, herein incorporated by reference in its entirety (Boehringer Ingelheim), WO 04/005286 (Gllead), WO 04/002977 (Pharmacia), WO 04/002944 (Pharmacia), WO 04/002940 (Pharmacia), WO 03/101993 (Neogenesis), WO 03/099824 (Wyeth), WO 03/099275 (Wyeth), WO 03/099801 (GSK)), WO 03/097646 (GSK), WO 03/095441 (Pfizer), WO 03/090674 (Viropharma), WO 03/084953 (B&C Biopharm), WO 03/082265 (Fujisawa), WO 03/082848 (Pfizer), WO 03/062211 (Merck), WO 03/059356 (GSK), EP 1321463 (Shire), WO 03/040 12 (Rigei), WO 03/037893 (GSK), WO 03/037894 (GSK), WO 03/037262 (GSK), WO 03/037895 (GSK), WO 03/026587 (BMS), WO 03/002518 (Dong Wha), WO 03/000254 (Japan Tobacco), WO 02/100846 A1 (Shire), WO 02/100851 A2 (Shire), WO 02/098424 A1 (GSK), WO 02/079187 (Dong Wha), WO 03/02/20497 (Shionogi), WO 02/06246 (Merck), WO 01/47883 (Japan Tobacco), WO 01/85172 A1 (GSK), WO 01/85720 (GSK), WO 01/77091 (Tularik), WO 00/18231 (Viropharma), WO 00/13708 (Viropharma), WO 01/10573 (Viropharma) WO 00/06529 (Merck), EP 1 256 628 A2 (Agouron), WO 02/04425 (Boehringer Ingelheim) WO 03/007945 (Boehringer Ingelheim), WO 03/010140 (Boehringer Ingelheim) and WO 03/010141 (Boehringer Ingelheim). Furthermore other inhibitors of HCV polymerase also include nucleoside analogs, for example, those compounds described in: WO 04/007512 (Merck/lsis), WO 04/003000 (Idenix), WO 04/002999 (Idenix), WO 04/0002422 (Idenix), WO 04/003138 (Merck), WO 03/105770 (Merck), WO 03/105770 (Merck), WO 03/093290 (Genelabs), WO 03/087298 (Biocryst), WO 03/062256 (Ribapharm), WO 03/062255 (Ribapharm), WO 03/061385 (Ribapharm), WO 03/026675 (Idenix), WO 03/026589 (Idenix), WO 03/020222 (Merck), WO 03/000713 (Glaxo), WO 02/100415 (Hoffmann-La Roche), WO 02/1094289 (Hoffmann-La Roche), WO 02/051425 (Mitsubishi), WO 02/18404 (Hoffmann-La Roche), WO 02/069903 (Biocryst Pharmaceuticals Inc.), WO 02/057287 (Merck/lsis), WO 02/057425 (Merck/lsis), WO 01/90121 (Idenix), WO 01/60315 (Shire) and WO 01/32153 (Shire). Specific examples of inhibitors of an HCV polymerase, include JTK-002, JTK-003 and JTK-109 (Japan Tobacco).
The term "inhibitor of another target in the HCV life cycle" as used herein means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the formation and/or replication of HCV in a mammal other than by inhibiting the function of the HCV NS3 protease. This includes agents that interfere with either host or HCV viral mechanisms necessary for the formation and/or replication of HCV in a mammal.
Inhibitors of another target in the HCV life cycle include, for example, agents that inhibit a target selected from helicase, NS2/3 protease and internal ribosome entry site (IRES). Specific examples of inhibitors of another target in the HCV life cycle include ISIS-14803 (ISIS Pharmaceuticals).
The term "HIV inhibitor" as used herein means an agents (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the formation and/or replication of HIV in a mammal. This includes agents that interfere with either host or viral mechanisms necessary for the formation and/or replication of HIV in a mammal. HIV inhibitors include, for example, nucleoside inhibitors, non-nucleoside inhibitors, protease inhibitors, fusion inhibitors and integrase inhibitors.
The term "HAV inhibitor" as used herein means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the formation and/or replication of HAV in a mammal. This includes agents that interfere with either host or viral mechanisms necessary for the formation and/or replication of HAV in a mammal. HAV inhibitors include Hepatitis A vaccines, for example, Havrix® (GlaxoSmithKline), VAQTA® (Merck) and Avaxim® (Aventis Pasteur).
The term "HBV inhibitor" as used herein means an agent (compound or biological) that is effective to inhibit the formation and/or replication of HBV in a mammal. This includes agents that interfere with either host or viral mechanisms necessary for the formation and/or replication of HBV in a mammal. HBV inhibitors include, for example, agents that inhibit HBV viral DNA polymerase or HBV vaccines. Specific examples of HBV inhibitors include Lamivudine (Epivir-HBV®), Adefovir Dipivoxil, Entecavir, FTC (Coviracil®), DAPD (DXG), L-FMAU (Clevudine®), AM365 (Amrad), Ldt (Telbivudine), monoval-LdC (Valtorcitabine), ACH-126,443 (L-Fd4C) (Achiilion), ' MCC478 (Eli Lilly), Racivir (RCV), Fluoro-L and D nucleosides, Robustafiavone, ICN 2001-3 (ICN), Bam 205 (Novelos), XTL-001 (XTL), Imino-Sugars (Nonyl-DNJ) (Synergy), HepBzyme; and immunomodulator products such as: interferon alpha 2b, HE2000 (Hollis-Eden), Theradigm (Epimmune), EHT899 (Enzo Biochem),
Thymosin alpha-1 (Zadaxin®), HBV DNA vaccine (PowderJect), HBV DNA vaccine (Jefferon Center), HBV antigen (OraGen), BayHep B® (Bayer), Nabi-HB® (Nabi) and Anti-hepatitis B (Cangene); and HBV vaccine products such as the following: Engerix B, Recombivax HB, GenHevac B, Hepacare, Bio-Hep B, TwinRix, Comvax, Hexavac.
The term "class I interferon" as used herein means an interferon selected from a group of interferons that all bind to receptor type I. This includes both naturally and synthetically produced class I interferons. Examples of class I interferons include α-; β-, δ-, ω- and τ-interferons, consensus interferons, asialo-interferons and pegylated forms thereof.
The term "class II interferon" as used herein means an interferon selected from a group of interferons that all bind to receptor type II. Examples of class II interferons include γ-interferons.
Specific preferred examples of some of these agents are listed below:
antiviral agents: ribavirin or amantadine;
immunomodulatory agents: class I interferons, class II interferons or pegylated forms thereof;
HCV polymerase inhibitors: nucleoside analogs or non-nucleosides;
inhibitor of another target in the HCV life cycle that inhibits a target selected from: NS3 helicase, NS2/3 protease or internal ribosome entry site (IRES);
■ HIV inhibitors: nucleosidic inhibitors, non-nucleosidic inhibitors, protease inhibitors, fusion inhibitors or integrase inhibitors; or HBV inhibitors: agents that inhibit viral DNA polymerase or is an HBV vaccine.
As discussed above, combination therapy is contemplated wherein a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, is co-administered with at least one additional agent selected from: an antiviral agent, an immunomodulatory agent, another inhibitor of HCV NS3 protease, an inhibitor of HCV polymerase, an inhibitor of another target in the HCV life cycle, an HIV inhibitor, an HAV inhibitor • and an HBV inhibitor. Examples of such agents are. provided in the Definitions section above. These additional agents may be combined with the compounds of this invention to create a single pharmaceutical dosage form. Alternatively these additional agents may be separately administered to the patient as part of a multiple dosage form, for example, using a kit. Such additional agents may be administered to the patient prior to, concurrently with, or following the administration of a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
As used herein, the term "treatment" means the administration of a compound or composition according to the present invention to alleviate or eliminate symptoms of the hepatitis C disease and/or to reduce viral load in a patient.
As used herein, the term "prevention" means the administration of a compound or composition according to the present invention post-exposure of the individual to the virus but before the appearance of symptoms of the disease, and/or prior to the detection of the virus in the blood, to prevent the appearance of symptoms of the disease.
As used herein, the designation whereby a bond to a substituent R is drawn as emanating from the center of a ring, such as, for example,
Figure imgf000016_0001
means that the substituent R may be attached to any free position on the ring that would otherwise be substituted with a hydrogen atom, unless specified otherwise. The following sign — or → are used interchangeably in sub-formulas to indicate the bond which is connected to the rest of the molecule as defined.
Preferred embodiments In the following preferred embodiments, groups and substituents of the compounds according to this invention are described in detail.
B is preferably selected from (C2.8)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyI and (C1-3)alkyl- (C3.7)cycloalkyl, a) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri- substituted with (Ct.3)alkyl; and b) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di-substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and O-(C1-4)alkyl; and c) wherein each of said alkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with fluorine or mono-substituted with chlorine or bromine; and d) wherein in each of said cycloalkyl groups being 5-, 6- or 7-membered, one or two -CH2-groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C-atoms.
More preferably, B is selected from ethyl, n-propyl, i-propyl, n-butyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2-methylpropyI, ferf-butyl, cyclopropyl, cyclόbutyl, cyclopentyl and cyclohexyl, a) wherein each of said groups is optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from methyl and ethyl; b) wherein each of said groups is optionally mono- or di-substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy, methoxy and ethoxy; and c) wherein each of said alkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with fluorine or mono-substituted with chlorine or bromine; and d) wherein in each of said cycloalkyl groups being 5-, 6- or 7-membered, one or two -CH2-groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C-atoms.
B is even more preferably selected from ethyl, 1-methylethyl, ,1-dimethylethyl, propyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2-methylpropyl, 1,1-dimethylpropyl, 1 ,2-dimethylpropyl, 2,2- dimethylpropyl, 1,1,2-trirnethylpropyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, 1-ethylpropyl, 1 -ethyl-2- methyipropyl, 1-(1-methylethyl)-2-methylpropyl, 1-ethyl-2,2-dimethylpropyl, butyl, 1- methylbutyl, 2-methylbutyl, 3-methylbutyl, 1 ,2-dimethylbutyl, 1, -dimethylbutyl, 1,3- dimethylbutyl, 2,2-dimethylbutyl, 2,3-dimethylbutyl, 3,3-dimethylbutyl, 1,2,2- trimethylbutyl, 1 ,2,3-trimethylbutyl, 2,2,3-trimethylbutyl, 2,3,3-trimethylbutyl and 2,2,3-trimethylbutyl, whereby these alkyl-groups may be substituted with chlorine or bromine, or with , 2 or 3 fluorine substituents. Examples of preferred fluorinated alkyl groups include, but are not limited to, 2-fluoroethyl, 3-fluoropropyl and 3,3,3- trifluoropropyl.
In addition, even more preferably, B is cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, or cyclohexyl or is selected from the following formulas, wherein one or two CH2- groups of a cycloalkyl group is replaced by oxygen:
Figure imgf000018_0001
From the above list, cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl groups optionally comprising 1 or 2 O-atoms are optionally substituted with 1 , 2 or 3 methyl-groups. Especially those cycloalkyl groups, optionally comprising 1 or 2 O-atoms, are preferred, wherein the -C-atom is substituted with methyl.
Further examples of preferred substituted cyclic groups are
Figure imgf000018_0002
Most preferably B is selected from ethyl, n-propyl, terf-butyl, 2-methylpropyl, 1,2- dimethylpropyl, 1 ,2,2-trimethylpropyl, 2-fluoroethyl, 3-fluoropropyl, 3,3,3- trifluoropropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl and 1 -methylcyclohexyl, and a group selected from:
Figure imgf000019_0001
Still, most preferably B is selected from ethyl, n-propyl, terf-butyl, cyclopentyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl, 2-fluoroethyl or 3-fluoropropyl.
According to one embodiment of this invention X is O.
According to another embodiment of this invention X is NH.
R3 is preferably (C2-6)alkyl, (C3.7)cycloalkyl or (Cι-3)alkyl-(C3.7)cycloalkyl, each of which being optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from (C1- )alkyl.
R3 is more preferably selected from ethyl, propyl, butyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, or cyclohexylmethyl, each of which optionally being substituted with 1 or 2 substituents selected from methyl, ethyl and propyl.
Even more preferably R3 is selected from 1-methylethyl, 1 ,1-dimethyiethyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2-methyl propyl, 1,1-dimethylpropyl, 1,2-dimethylpropyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl, 1- methylcyclohexyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, (l-methylcyclopentyl)methyl and ( -methylcyclohexyl)methyl.
R3 is most preferably selected from 1,1-dimethylethyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl and 1 -methylcyclohexyl.
Still, R is most preferably selected from 1,1-dimethylethyl and cyclohexyl.
L° is preferably selected from H, halogen, CH3, -OH, -OCH3, -OC2H5, -OC3H7) -OCH(CH3)2, -NHCH3l -NHC2H5, -NHC3H7, -NHCH(CH3)2, -N(CH3)2, -N(CH3)C2H5, N(CH3)C3H7 and -N(CH3)CH(CH3)2. Most preferably Lu is selected from H, -OH, -OCH3, halogen and -N(CH3)2.
Even most preferably, L° is H, -OH or-OCH3.
Still, most preferably, L° is H or -OCH3.
L1 and L2are preferably each independently selected from: halogen, -CH3, -C2H5, -OCH3, -OC2H5, -OC3H7, -OCH(CH3)2, CF3, -SMe, -SOMe, and SO2Me whereby either L1 or L2 may be H.
More preferably either one of L1 and L2 is -CH3, -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO2Me and the other of L1 and L2 is H.
Most preferably L1 is CH3, -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO2Me and L2 is H.
Therefore, preferably L° is selected from: H, -OH and -OCH3; and either one of L1 and L2is CH3, -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO2Me and the other of L1 and L2is H.
More preferably L° is selected from H, -OH and -OCH3; L1 is - CH3, -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO2Me; and L2 is H.
Most preferably L° is H or -OCH3; L1 is -CH3, Ci or Br; and L2is H.
In the case L° and L1 are covalently bonded to form together with the quinoline residue to which they are linked a ring system, this ring system is preferably selected from:
Figure imgf000020_0001
wherein Xa, Xb are independently selected from CH2) O and NRa; most preferably O;
Ra is each independently H or (C1- )alkyl;
R is each independently (Chal y!;
L2 is as defined; preferably H or methyl, particularly H.
In the case L° and L2 are covalently bonded to form together with the quinoline residue to which they are linked a ring system, this ring system is preferably selected from:
Figure imgf000021_0001
wherein
Xa, Xb are independently selected from CH2, O and NRa; most preferably O;
Ra is each independently H or (C1- )alkyl;
Rb is each independently (C1-4)alkyl;
L1 is as defined; preferably H or methyl, particularly H.
More preferably, L° and L1 are covalently bonded to form, together with the quinoline residue to Which they are linked, a ring system which is selected from:
Figure imgf000021_0002
wherein each R is independently (C1-4)alkyl and L2 is as defined; preferably H or methyl, particularly H. Most preferably, L° and L are covalently bonded to form together with the quinoline residue to which they are linked a ring system selected from
Figure imgf000022_0001
wherein L2 is H or -CH3, preferably H
R2 is preferably R20, -NHCOR20, -NHCOOR20, -NHR21 and -NHCONR21R23, wherein R20 is selected from (Chalky!, (C3-7)cycloalkyl, (Cι.3)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with
(Cι-3)alkyl; and
R21 is H or R20 as defined above; and
R23 is H or methyl; most preferably H.
More preferably, R2 is R20, NHCOR20, -NHCOOR20, -NHR21 -and -NHCONR21R23, wherein
R20 is selected from methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, /-propyl, n-butyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2- methylpropyl, tert-butyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, 1 ,1-dimethylpropyl, 1,2-dimethylpropyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl- methyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, and cyclohexylmethyl, each of said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl groups being optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from methyl and ethyl, in particular methyl; and
R21 is H or R20 as defined above; and R23 is H or methyl; most preferably H.
Preferably, R2 is selected from: a) amino, Λ/-methylamino, Λ/-ethy!amino, N-propylamino, Λ/-(1-methylethyl)amino, A/-( ,1-dimethylethy[)amino, /V-(2-methylpropyl)amino, Λ/-(1-methylpropyl)amino, N-(2,2-dimethyIpropyl)amino, A/-(1,2-dimethylpropyl)amino, Λ/-(1,1- dimethylpropyl)amino, Λ/-cyclopropylamino, Λ/-cyclobuty!amino-, Λ/-cyclopentylamino~, Λ/-cyclohexylamino-, Λ/-(cyclopropylmethyl)amino, Λ/-(cyclobutylmethyl)amino, Λ/-(cyclopentylmethyl)amino, and Λ/-(cyclohexylmethyl)amino; b) methylcarbonylamino, ethylcarbonylamino, 1-methylethylcarbonylamino, propylcarbonylamino, 2-methylpropylcarbonylamino, 1-methylpropyl- carbonylamino, 2,2-dimethylpropylcarbonylamino, 1 ,2-dimethylpropyIcarbonyl- a ino, 1,1-djmethylpropylcarbonylamino, cyclopropylcarbonylamino, cyclobutylcarbonylamino, cyclopentylcarbonylamino, cyclohexylcarbonylamino, cyclopropylmethylcarbonylamino, cyclobutylmethylcarbonylamino, cyclopentylmethylcarbonylamino, cyclohexylmethylcarbonylamino; and c) methoxycarbonylamino, ethoxycarbonylamino, 1-methylethoxycarbonylamino, propoxycarbonylamino, terf-butoxycarbonylamino, cyclopropyloxycarbonylamino, cyclobutyloxycarbonylamino, cyclopentyloxycarbonylamino, cyclohexyloxycarbonylamino, cyclopropylmethoxycarbonylamino, cyclobutylmethoxycarbonylamino, cyclopentylmethoxycarbonylamino, cyclohexylmethoxycarbonylamino; wherein all said cycloalkyl or alkyl-cycloalkyl groups may be mono- or disubstituted with methyl.
Most preferably R2 is -NHCOR20, -NHCOOR20, or -NHR21, wherein R20 and R21 are as defined herein.
Preferably, R20 and R21 are independently selected from: methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, /'- propyl, n-butyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2-methylpropyl, fe/f-butyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, 1,1- dimethylpropyl, 1 ,2-dimethylpropyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, each of said cycloalkyl or alkyl-cycloalkyl groups optionally being mono- or di-substituted with methyl or ethyl.
More preferably, R20 and R21 are independently selected from: methyl, ethyl, n- propyl, /-propyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, cyclopentyl and cyclopentylmethyl.
In the moiety P1 the substituent R1 and the carbonyl take a syn orientation. Therefore, in the case R1 is ethyl, the asymmetric carbon atoms in the cyclopropyl group take the R,R configuration according to the subformula:
Figure imgf000024_0001
In the case R1 is vinyl, the asymmetric carbon atoms in the cyclopropyl group take the R,S configuration according to the subformula:
Figure imgf000024_0002
R1 is preferably vinyl.
Rc is preferably selected from hydroxy or NHSO2Rs wherein Rs is methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, /-propyl, n-butyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2- methylpropyl, ferf-butyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, phenyl, naphthyl, pyridinyl, phenylmethyl (benzyl), naphthylmethyl or pyridinylmethyl; a) each of which optionally being mono-, di- or tri-substituted with substituents selected from fluorine and methyl; and b) each of which optionally being mono- or disubstituted with substituents selected from hydroxy, trifluoromethyl, methoxy and trifluoromethoxy; and c) each of which optionally being rinonosubstituted with substituents selected from chlorine, bromine, cyano, nitro, -CO-NH2, -CO-NHCH3) -CO-N(CH3)2, -NH2, -NH(CH3) and -N(CH3)2.
Alternatively preferably, Rc is NHSO2Rs , wherein Rs is -N(RN2)RN1), wherein RN1 and RN2 are independently selected from H, (C1-4)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl, (Cι.3)alkyl-
(C3-7)cycloalkyl, phenyl, and (C1-3)alkyl-phenyl; wherein said (C^alkyl,
(C3-7)cycloalkyl, (Cι-3)alkyl-(C3.7)cycloaIkyl, phenyl and (C1-3)alkyl-phenyl are optionally substituted with one, two or three substituents independently selected from halogen, (C^alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, O-(Cι-6)alkyl, -NH2, -NH(C1- )alkyl, -N((C1-4)alkyl)2, -CO-NH2, -CO-NH(C )alkyl, -CO-N((C^)alkyl)2, -COOH, and - COO(C1-6)alkyl; or
RN2 and RN1 are linked, together with the nitrogen to which they are bonded, to form a 5 or 6-membered monocyclic heterocycle which may be saturated or. unsaturated, optionally containing from one to three further heteroatoms independently selected from N, S and O, and optionally substituted with one, two or three substituents independently selected from halogen, (Cι-6)alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, O-(C1-6)alkyl, -. NH2, -NH C^alkyl, -N((C1-4)alkyl)2lι -CO-NH2, -CO-NH(C1-4)alkyl, -CO-N((C1-4)alkyl)2, -COOH, and -COO(C1-6)alkyl.
Preferably, the group Rc is hydroxy, NHSO2-methyl, NHSO2-ethyl, NHSO2-(1- methyl)ethyl, NHSO2-propyl, NHSO2-cyclopropyl, NHSO2-CH2-cyclopropyl, NHSO2- cyclobutyl, NHSO2-cyclopentyl, or NHSO2-phenyl.
More preferably, Rc is hydroxy, or NHSO2-cyclopropyl.
According to a most preferred embodiment, the group Rc is hydroxy. According to an alternative most preferred embodiment, the group Rc is NHSO2-cyclopropyl. According to another alternative most preferred embodiment, the group Rc is NHSO2N(CH3)2.
Also encompassed within the scope of the present invention, are compounds of formula (I) wherein:
B is (Cι.10)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl, or (C1^)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, a) wherein said cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-
substituted with (C1-3)alkyl; and b) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di- substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and O-(C1-4)alkyl; and c) wherein all said alkyl-groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with ' halogen; and d) wherein all said cycloalkyl-groups being 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered having optionally one (for the 4-, 5, 6, or 7-membered) or two (for the 5-, 6- or 7- membered) -CH2-groups not directly linked to each other replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C-atoms; X is O or NH;
R3 is (C2-8)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl or (C -3)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C1-4)alkyl;
L° is H, -OH, -O-(C1-4)alkyl, -NH2, -NH(C^)alkyl or -N((C1-4)alkyl)2;
L1, L2 are each independently halogen, (C1-4)alkyl, -O-(C1-4)alkyl or -S-(CM)alkyl (in any oxidized state such as SO or SO2); and either L or Lz (but not both at the same time) may also be H; or
L° and L1 or
L° and L2 may be covalently bonded to form, together with the two C-atoms to which they are linked, a 5- or 6-membered carbocyclic ring wherein one or two
-CH2-groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced each independently by -O- or NRa wherein Ra is H or (C^alkyl, and wherein said carbo- or heterocyclic ring is optionally mono- or di-substituted with (C1-4)alkyl;
R2 is R20, -NR22COR20, -NR22COOR20 -NR22R21 and -NR22CONR21R23, wherein R20 is selected from (C1-a)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl and (C1- )alkyl- (C3- )cycloalkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (Cι-3)alkyl; R2 is H or has one of the meanings, of R20 as defined above,
R22 and R23 are independently selected from H and methyl,
R1 is ethyl or vinyl;
Rc is hydroxy or NHSO2Rs wherein Rs is (C1.6)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl, (C1-6)alkyl- (C3-7)cycloalkyl, phenyl, naphthyl, pyridinyl,
Figure imgf000026_0001
(C1-4)alkyl- naphthyl or (C1-4)alkyl-pyridinyl; all of which optionally being mono-, di- or tri- substituted with substituents selected from halogen, hydroxy, cyano, (C1-4)alkyl, O-(C1-6)alkyl, -CO-NH2, -CO-NH(C1-4)alkyl, -CO-N((C1-4)alkyl)2, -NH2, -NH(C1-4)alkyl and -N((Ci-4)aikyl)2; and all of which optionally being monosubstituted with nitro; or Rs can be further selected from: -NH(C1-6)alkyl, N((C1-6)alkyl)2, -Het, .
Figure imgf000027_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof.
Preferably,
B is (C2-8)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl or (C1-3)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, a) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri- substituted with (C1-3)alkyl; and b) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di- substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and ©-(Ct^alkyl; and c) wherein each of said alkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with fluorine or mono-substituted with chlorine or bromine; and d) wherein in each of said cycloalkyl groups being 5-, 6- or 7-membered, one or two -CH2-groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C-atoms;
X < is O or NH; R3 is (C2.6)alkyl or (C3-7)cycloalkyl, both of which being optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from
Figure imgf000027_0002
L° is H, -OH, -OCH3, halogen or -N(CH3)2;
L1 and L2 are each independently selected from: halogen, -CH3, -C2H5, -OCH3,
-OC2H5, -OC3H7, -OCH(CH3)2, CF3, -SMe, -SOMe, and SO2Me, whereby either L1 or L2 may be H;
R2 is R20, -NHCOR20, -NHCOOR20, -NHR21 and -NHCONR21R23, wherein
R20 is selected from (C^alkyl, (C3- )cycloalkyl, (Cι.3)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, wherein each of said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C1-3)alkyl; and
R21 is H or R20 as defined above; and
R23 is H or methyl;
R1 is ethyl or vinyl; and Rc is hydroxy, NHSO2-methyl, NHSO2-ethyl, NHSO2-(1-methyl)ethyl, NHSO2- propyl, NHSO2-cyclopropyl, NHSO2-CH2-cyclopropyl, NHSO2-cyclobutyl, NHSO2- cyclopentyl or NHSO2-phenyl.
More preferably, B is selected from: ethyl, n-propyl, tetf-butyl, 2-methylpropyl, 1 ,2- dimethylpropyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, 2-fluoroethyl, 3-fluoropropyl, 3,3,3- trifluoropropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl and 1 -methylcyclohexyl, and a group selected from:
Figure imgf000028_0001
R3is selected from 1,1-dimethylethyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl and 1- methylcyclohexyl; L° is H, -OH or-OCH3; L1 is CH3, -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or
-SO2Me; L2 is H;
R2 is -NHCOR20, -NHCOOR20 or -NHR21, wherein R20 and R21 are independently selected from methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, /-propyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, cyclopentyl and cyclopentylmethyl;
R1 is vinyl; and Rc is hydroxy or NHSO2-cyclopropyl.
Most preferably, B is selected from ethyl, n-propyl, .erf-butyl, cyclopentyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl, 2-fluoroethyl and 3-fluoropropyl; R3 is selected from 1,1- dimethylethyl and cyclohexyl; L° is H or -OCH3; L is -CH3, -Cl, or -Br; L2 is H; and Rc is hydroxy.
Examples of preferred embodiments according to this invention is each single compound listed in the following Tables 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6.
According to an alternate embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition of this invention may additionally comprise at least one other anti-HCV agent. Examples of anti-HCV agents include, α- (alpha), β- (beta), δ- (delta), γ- (gamma), ω- (omega) or τ- (tau) interferon, pegylated -interferon, ribavirin and amantadine.
According to another alternate embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition of this invention may additionally comprise at least one other inhibitor of HCV NS3 protease.
According to another alternate embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition of this invention may additionally comprise at least one inhibitor of HCV polymerase.
According to yet another alternate embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition of this invention may additionally comprise at least one inhibitor of other targets in the HCV life cycle, including but not limited to, helicase, NS2/3 protease or internal ribosome entry site (IRES).
The pharmaceutical composition of this invention may be administered orally, parenterally or via an implanted reservoir. Oral administration or administration by injection is preferred. The pharmaceutical composition of this invention may contain any conventional non-toxic pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers, adjuvants or vehicles. In some cases, the pH of the formulation may be adjusted with pharmaceutically acceptable acids, bases or buffers to enhance the stability of the formulated compound or its delivery form. The term parenteral as used herein includes subcutaneous, intracutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, intra-articular, intrasynovial, intrasternal, intrathecal, and intralesional injection or infusion techniques.
The pharmaceutical composition may be in the form of a sterile injectable preparation, for example, as a sterile injectable aqueous or oleaginous suspension. This suspension may be formulated according to techniques known in the art using suitable dispersing or wetting agents (such as, for example Tween 80) and suspending agents.
The pharmaceutical composition of this invention may be orally administered in any orally acceptable dosage form including, but not limited to, capsules, tablets, and aqueous suspensions and solutions. In the case of tablets for oral use, carriers which are commonly used include lactose and corn starch. Lubricating agents, such as magnesium stearate, are also typically added. For oral administration in a capsule form, useful diluents include lactose and dried corn starch. When aqueous suspensions are administered orally, the active ingredient is combined with emulsifying and suspending agents. If desired, certain sweetening and/or flavoring and/or coloring agents may be added.
Other suitable vehicles or carriers for the above noted formulations and compositions can be found in standard pharmaceutical texts, e.g. in "Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences", The Science and Practice of Pharmacy, 9th Ed. Mack Publishing Company, Easton, Penn., (1995).
Dosage levels of between about 0.01 and about 100 mg/kg body weight per day, preferably between about 0.1 and about 50 mg/kg body weight per day of the protease inhibitor compound described herein are useful in a monotherapy for the prevention and treatment of HCV mediated disease. Typically, the pharmaceutical composition of this invention will be administered from about 1 to about 5 times per day or alternatively, as a continuous infusion. Such administration can be used as a chronic or acute therapy. The amount of active ingredient that may be combined with the carrier materials to produce a single dosage form will vary depending upon the host treated and the particular mode of administration. A typical preparation will contain from about 5% to about 95% active compound (w/w). Preferably, such preparations contain from about 20% to about 80% active compound.
As the skilled artisan will appreciate, lower or higher doses than those recited above may be required. Specific dosage and treatment regimens for any particular patient will depend upon a variety of factors, including the activity of the specific compound employed, the age, body weight, general health status, sex, diet, time of administration, rate of excretion, drug combination, the severity and course of the infection, the patient's disposition to the infection and the judgment of the treating physician. Generally, treatment is initiated with small dosages substantially less than the optimum dose of the peptide. Thereafter, the dosage is increased by small increments until the optimum effect under the circumstances is reached. In general, the compound is most desirably administered at a concentration level that will generally afford antivirally effective results without causing any harmful or deleterious side effects. When the composition of this invention comprises a combination of a compound of formula I and one or more additional therapeutic or prophylactic agent, both the compound and the additional agent should be present at dosage levels of between about 10 to 100%, and more preferably between about 10 and 80% of the dosage normally administered in a monotherapy regimen.
When these compounds, including their pharmaceutically acceptable salts and esters, are formulated together with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, the resulting composition may be administered in vivo to mammals, such as man, to inhibit HCV NS3 protease or to treat or prevent HCV virus infection. Such treatment may also be achieved using a compound of this invention in combination with another antiviral agent. Preferred other antiviral agents are described within the Definitions section and the section of preferred pharmaceutical compositions according to this invention and include, but are not limited to: α~, β-, δ-, ω-, γ- or τ- interferon, ribavirin, amantadine; other inhibitors of HCV NS3 protease; inhibitors of HCV polymerase; inhibitors of other targets in the HCV life cycle, which include but are not limited to, helicase, NS2/3 protease, or internal ribosome entry site (IRES); or combinations thereof. The additional agents may be combined with compounds of this invention to create a single dosage form. Alternatively these additional agents may be separately administered to a mammal as part of a multiple dosage form. .
Accordingly, another embodiment of this invention provides a method of inhibiting HCV NS3 protease activity in a mammal by administering a compound of the formula I, including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof.
In a preferred embodiment, this method is useful in decreasing the NS3 protease activity of the hepatitis C virus infecting a mammal.
As discussed above, combination therapy is contemplated wherein a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, is co-administered with at least one additional antiviral agent. Preferred antiviral agents are described hereinbefore and examples of such agents are provided in the Definitions section. These additional agents may be combined with the compounds of this invention to create a single pharmaceutical dosage form. Alternatively these additional agents may be separately administered to the patient as part of a multiple dosage form, for example, using a kit. Such additional agents may be administered to the patient prior to, concurrently with, or following the administration of a compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof.
A compound of formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, set forth herein may also be used as a laboratory reagent. Furthermore a compound of this invention, including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, may also be used to treat or prevent viral contamination of materials and therefore reduce the risk of viral infection of laboratory or medical personnel or patients who come in contact with such materials (e.g. blood, tissue, surgical instruments and garments, laboratory instruments and garments, and blood collection apparatuses and materials).
A compound of formula (I), including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, set forth herein may also be used as a research reagent. A compound of formula (I), including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, may also be used as positive control to validate surrogate cell-based assays or in vitro or in vivo viral replication assays.
METHODOLOGY
Several ways of carrying out the synthesis of compounds of formula I with different quinoline derivatives are disclosed in WO 00/09558. The dipeptide intermediate 15 (Scheme 2) and 2-carbomethoxy-4-hydroxy-7-methoxyquinoline 9 (Scheme 1 ) were synthesized according to the general methods described in WO 00/09543.
Compounds of formula I wherein Rc is NHSO2Rs as defined herein are prepared by coupling the corresponding acid of formula I (i.e. Rc is hydroxy) with an appropriate sulfonamide of formula RsSO2NH2 in the presence of a coupling agent under standard conditions. Although several commonly used coupling agents can be employed, TBTU and HATU have been found to be practical. The sulfonamides are available commercially or can be prepared by known methods. The following schemes illustrate two convenient processes using known methods for preparing the compounds of formula 1 when R1 is vinyl and Rc is OH.
Scheme 1
Figure imgf000033_0001
Briefly, the synthesis of dipeptide 3 is carried out by coupling the P1 residue to the properly protected .rans-hydroxy proline under standard conditions. The stereochemistry of the hydroxyl group is inverted by the well known Mitsunobu reaction using para-nitrobenzoic acid. Coupling of dipeptide with the P3 moiety (prepared using standard methodology and exemplified in the examples section) yielded tripeptide 6. Introduction of the quinoline moiety to the hydroxyl group of the tripeptide 7 with inversion of stereochemistry can be carried out using either a Mitsunobu reaction or by converting the free hydroxyl group into a good leaving group (such as a brosylate) and displacing it with the hydroxyl quinoline derivative 9. For the synthesis of the 2-(2-amino-4-thiazolyl) derivatives, the quinoline used contains a 2-carbomethoxy group as shown in 9. Conversion of the carboxylate group to the aminothiazole derivative is carried out by well known synthetic methodology and is described and exemplified in WO 00/09543 and WO 00/09598. Finally the C-terminal ester is hydrolyzed under basic aqueous conditions. Scheme 2
Figure imgf000034_0001
Scheme 2 describes another reaction sequence for making compounds of Formula I. In this case the quinoline moiety is introduced to the dipeptide in a similar way as described in Scheme 1. Finally, the P3 moiety is coupled under standard conditions to the dipeptide 21. Conversion of the resulting tripeptide to the final compound is carried out as described in Scheme 1.
SYNTHESIS OF P1 FRAGMENTS
P1 moieties of compounds of Formula (I) were prepared using the protocols outlined in WO 00/59929, published October 12, 2000, and WO 00/09543, published on February 24, 2000. In particular, reference is made to pages 33-35, Example 1 of WOOO/59929 and Pages 56-69 , Example 9 - 20 of WOOO/09543 for the preparation of 1-aminocyclopropanecarboxylic acid P1 moieties.
SYNTHESIS OF P2 SUBSTITUENTS
Compounds of formula 9 can be synthesized from commercially available materials using the techniques described in International Patent Applications WO 00/59929, WO 00/09543, WO 00/09558 and U.S. Patent 6,323,180 B1.
Examples of synthesis of different 2-carbomethoxy-4-hydroxyquinoline derivatives were carried out as follows: Synthesis of 2-carbomethoxy-4-hydroxy-quinoline derivatives was carried out from the corresponding anilines according to the procedure of : Unangst, P.C.; Connor, D.T. J. Heterocyc. Chem. 29, 5, 1992, 1097-1100. The procedure is shown in scheme 3 below:
Figure imgf000035_0001
Briefly, properly substituted anilines at the 2, 3 and/or 4 position are allowed to react with dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate and the resulting enamine is heated at high , temperatures to effect the cyclization.
The corresponding anilines are commercially available or may require some well known chemical transformation. For example it can be that the nitro is commercially available and is then converted to the corresponding amine by using a reducing agent. Also when the carboxylic acid is commercially available, it can be transformed into the corresponding amine via a Curtius rearrangement.
Further details of the invention are illustrated in the following examples which are understood to be non-limiting with respect to the appended claims. Other specific ways of synthesis or resolution of the compounds of this invention can be found in WO 00/09543; WO 00/09558 & WO 00/59929 and in co-pending application 09/368,670, all of which are hereby incorporated by reference. EXAMPLES
Temperatures are given in degrees Celsius. Solution percentages express a weight to volume relationship, and solution ratios express a volume to volume relationship, unless stated otherwise. Nuclear magnetic resonance (NMR) spectra were recorded on a Bruker 400 MHz spectrometer; the chemical shifts (δ) are reported in parts per million. Flash chromatography was carried out on silica gel (SiO2) according to Still's flash chromatography technique (W.C. Still et al., J. Org. Chem., (1978), 43, 2923).
Abbreviations used in the examples include:
BOC or Boc: terf-butyloxycarbonyl; DBU: 1,8-diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene; DCM: dichloromethane; DIAD: diisopropylazodicarboxylate; DIEA: diisopropylethylamine; DIPEA: diisopropylethyl amine; DMF: N, N-dimethylformamide; DMAP: 4- (dimethylamino)pyridine; DMSO: dimethylsulfoxide; EtOAc: ethyl acetate; HATU: [O- 7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)-1,1,3,3-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate]; HPLC: high performance liquid chromatography; MS: mass spectrometry (MALDI-TOF: Matrix Assisted Laser Desorption lonization-Time of Flight, FAB: Fast Atom Bombardment); Me: methyl; MeOH: methanol; Ph: phenyl; R.T.: room temperature (18 to 22°); terf-butyl or t-butyl: 1,1-dimethylethyl; Tbg: ferf-butyl glycine: tenf-leucine; TBTU: 2-(1 H-benzotriazole-1-yl)-1 ,1 ,3,3-tetramethyl uranium tetrafluoroborate; TEA: triethylamine; TFA: trifluoroacetic acid; and THF: tetrahydrofuran.
EXAMPLE 1
Synthesis of P3 derivatives: Synthesis of carbamate 4a
Figure imgf000036_0001
4a THF (350 mL) was added to a flask containing carbonic acid cyclopentyl ester 2,5- dioxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl ester (9.00 g; 39.6 mol) and terf-butyl glycine (6.24 g; 47.5 mmol) resulting in a suspension. Distilled water (100 mL) was added with vigorous stirring. A small amount of solid remained undissolved. Triethylamine ( 6.6 mL; 119 mmol) was then added resulting in a homogenous solution which was stirred at R.T. After 2.5 h, the THF was evaporated and the aqueous residue diluted with water (100 mL). The reaction was rendered basic by the addition of 1 N NaOH (25 mL - final pH >10). The solution was washed with EtOAc (2x 200 mL) and the aqueous phase acidified with 1 N HCI (ca. 70 mL - final pH <2). The turbid solution was extracted with EtOAc (200 + 150 mL). The extract was dried (MgSO4) and evaporated to give carbamate 4a as a white solid (8.68 g).
Preparation of Ureas 5a
Figure imgf000037_0001
5a A solution of terf-butyl glycine benzyl ester hydrochloride salt (2.55 g; 9.89 mmol) in THF (20 mL) and pyridine (2.0 mL; 24.73 mmol) was cooled to 0°C. Phenyl chloroformate (1.30 mL; 10.19 mmol) was added dropwise to the cooled solution. The resulting suspension was stirred for 5 min at 0°C, then at R.T. for 1.5 h. The reaction mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed with 10% citric acid (2x), water (2x), saturated NaHCO3 (2x), water (2x) and brine (1x), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated to obtain the crude compound as a nearly colorless oil (3.73 g; >100%; assume 9.89 mmol). The crude product (1.01 g; 2.97 mmol) was dissolved in DMSO (6.5 mL) and cyclopentylamine was added dropwise. The reaction mixture was stirred at R.T. for 45 min and then diluted with EtOAc. The organic phase was washed with 10% citric acid (2x), water (2x), saturated NaHCO3 (2x), water (2x) and brine (1x), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated to give the crude cyclopentyl urea -Tbg-OBn product as a nearly colorless oil. The crude material was purified by flash column chromatography with silica using hexane:EtOAc 9:1 to remove the less polar impurities and 7:3 to elute the purified product as a thick colorless oil (936 mg; 95%o). The benzyl ester product (936 mg; 2.82 mmol) was deprotected under a hydrogen filled balloon at R.T. in absolute ethanol (15 mL) solution by stirring the solution with 10% Pd/C (93.6 mg) for 5.5 h. The reaction mixture was filtered through a 0.45 micron filter and evaporated to dryness to provide urea 5a as a white solid (669 mg; 98%) 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 12.39 (s, 1H), 6.09 (d, J = 7.4 Hz, 1H), 5.93 (d, J = 9.4 Hz, 1H), 3.90 (d, J = 9.4 Hz, 1H), 3.87-3.77 (m, 1H), 1.84-1.72 (m, 2H), 1.63-1.42 (m, 4H), 1.30-1.19 (m, 2H), 0.89 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 241.0 (M-H)" 243.0 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06% TFA; C.H3CN : H2O) : 99%.
EXAMPLE 2
Synthesis of Thioureas 8
Synthesis of thiourea 8a:
Figure imgf000038_0001
8a To a solution of te/ -butyl isothiocyanate (5.0 mL; 39.4 mmoL) in DCM (200 mL) was added cyclopentylamine (4.67 mL; 47.3 mmoL) followed by DIPEA and the reaction mixture was stirred at R.T. for 2 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc, and washed with a 10% aqueous solution of citric acid (2x), saturated NaHCO3 (2x), . H2O (2x) and brine (1x). The organic layer was dried over anhydrous MgSO , filtered and evaporated to yield ΛMen!-butyl-Λ/-cyclopentylthiourea as a white solid (3.70 g; 47% yield). The Λ/-.erf-butyl-Λ/'rcyclopentylthiourea (3.70 g) was. dissolved in concentrated HCl (46 mL). The dark yellow solution was heated at a gentle reflux. After 40 min the reaction mixture was aliowed to cool to R.T. and thereafter cooled in ice and rendered basic to pH 9.5 with solid and a saturated aqueous solution of NaHCO3. The product was extracted into EtOAc (3x). The combined EtOAc extracts were washed with H2O (2x) and brine (1x). The organic layer was dried (MgSO4), filtered and concentrated to yield a beige solid (2.46 g crude). Trituration of the crude material in hexane/ EtOAc 95 / 5 provided, after filtration, the N- cyclopentythiourea 8a as a white solid (2.38 g; 90% yield). 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-de): δ 7.58 (bs, 1H), 7.19 (bs, 1H), 6.76 (bs, 1H), 4.34 (bs, 1H), 1.92-1.79 (m,2H), 1.66-1.55 (m, 2H), 1.55-1.30 (m,4H). MS; es+ 144.9 (M + H)+, es": 142.8 (M - H)'.
Preparation of Thiourea 8b
Figure imgf000039_0001
8b
Thiourea (5.0 g, 66 mmol) was dissolved in toluene (50 mL) and terf-butylacetyl chloride (8.88 g, 66 mmol) was added. The mixture was heated at reflux for 14 h to give a yellow solution. The mixture was concentrated to dryness, and the residue partitioned between EtOAc and sat. NaHCO3. The yellow organic phase was dried over MgSO , filtered and concentrated to give a yellow solid. The solid was dissolved into a minimum amount of EtOAc and triturated with hexane to give 8b as a white solid (8.52 g; 75%). M.S. (electrospray): 173 (M-H)" 175 (M+H)+. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %.
Preparation of Thiourea 8c
Figure imgf000039_0002
8c
Using the procedure described above but using commercially available cyclopentyl acetyl chloride instead of fert-butylacetyl chloride yielded thiourea 8c.
SYNTHESIS OF 2-CARBOMETHOXY-4-HYDROXY QUINOLINE DERIVATIVES
EXAMPLE 3A
Synthesis of 2-carbomethoxy-4-hydroxy-7-methoxy-8-methylquinoline (A5)
Step A
Figure imgf000039_0003
To a solution of 2-methyl-3-nit.ro anisole A1 (5.1 g; 30.33 mmol; requires -30 min to dissolve) in absolute ethanol (85 mL) was added 10% Pd/C catalyst (500 mg) . The solution was hydrogenated under a hydrogen filled balloon at atmospheric pressure and room temperature for 19 h. The reaction mixture was filtered through a Celite pad, rinsed and evaporated to dryness to obtain 2-methyl-3-methoxyaniline A2 as a deep mauve oil (4.1 g; 29.81 mmol; 98 % yield). . MS 137 (MH)+. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity @ 220 rim (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99%.
Step B
Figure imgf000040_0001
Dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate A3 (3.6 mL, 29.28 mmol) was added dropwise to a solution of 2-methyl-3-methoxyaniline A2 (3.95 g, 28.79 mmol) in MeOH (100 mL) (reaction is exothermic). The mixture was heated at a gentle reflux for 5 hours cooled and concentrated under vacuum. The crude material was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel with hexane : EtOAc (95 : 5) to provide, after evaporation of the pure fractions, the product A4 (6.5 g; 23.27 mmol; 81 % yield). Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity @ 220 nm (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 95%.
Step C
li
Figure imgf000040_0002
Figure imgf000040_0003
The diester A4 (6.5 g, 23.27 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (12 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 350- 400°C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 240°C (observe MeOH evolution at 230-240°C) a count of six minutes was begun before the bath (temperature end point: 262°C) was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature. A solid formed upon cooling which was diluted with ether, filtered and dried to give a tan brown solid (3.48 g crude). The crude material was chromatographed on silica gel column with hexane : EtOAc; 5 : 5 to remove impurities, then 2 : 8 and then 100 % EtOAc to complete the elution of the product to provide A5, after evaporation, as a pale yellow solid (2.1 g, 37% yield).
MS (M + H)+; 246, and (M - H)"; 248.1. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity @ 220 nm (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O): 99 %. EXAMPLE 3B
Synthesis of 2-carbomethoxy-8-bromo-4-hydroxy-7-methoxyquinolϊne (B6)
Figure imgf000041_0001
Step A 2-Amino-3-nitrophenol B1 (5 g; 32.4 mmol) was dissolved in H2O (29.5 mL) and 1,4- dioxane (14.7 mL). The mixture was heated to reflux and hydrobromic acid (48%; 16.7 mL; 147 mmol) was added dropwise over a period of 20 min. Upon completion of the addition, the reflux was maintained an additional 15 min. The reaction was cooled to 0°C (ice bath), and sodium nitrite (2.23 g; 32.3 mmol) in H2O (20 mL) was added over a period of 30 min. The stirring was continued for 5 min at 0°C, then the mixture was transferred to a jacketed dropping funnel (0°C) and added dropwise to a stirred mixture of Cu(l)Br (5.34 g; 37.2 mmol) in H2O (29.5 mL) and HBr (48%; 16.7 mL; 147 mmol) at 0°C. The reaction was stirred for 15 min at 0°C, warmed to 60°C, stirred for an additional 15 min, cooled to room temperature, and left to stir overnight. The reaction mixture was transferred to a separatory funnel and extracted with ether (3x 150 mL). The organic layers were combined, washed with brine (1X), dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated to afford the crude product (7.99 g) as a red-brown oil. The crude material was purified by flash column chromatography (1:25 ultra pure silica gel, 230-400 mesh, 40-60 mm, 60 angstroms; CH2CI2as the ' solvent) to afford pure 2-bromo-3-nitrophenol B2 (45%; 3.16 g) as an orange-brown solid. MS 217.8 (MH)\ Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 97%.
Step B The nitrophenol starting material B2 (3.1 g; 14.2 mmol) was dissolved in DMF (20 mL) and to the solution was added ground cesium carbonate (5.58 g; 17.1 mmol) followed by Mel (2.6 mL; 42.5 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. The DMF was evaporated, the residue taken up in ether (1x 200 mL), washed with water (1x 200 mL), brine (4x 00 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated to afford the crude 2-bromo-3-nitroanisole B3 (94%; 3.1 g) as an orange solid.
MS 234 (M+2H)+; Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 98%.
Ste C
2-Bromo-3-nitroanisole B3 (1.00 g; 4.31 mmol) was dissolved in glacial acetic acid (11.0 mL) and ethanol (11.0 mL). To this solution was added iron powder (0.98 g; 17.5 mmol). The mixture was stirred at reflux for 3.5 h and worked up. The reaction mixture was diluted with water (35 mL), neutralized with solid Na2CO3 and the product extracted with CH2CI2(3X 50 mL). The extracts were dried (Na2SO ), filtered and concentrated in vacuo to afford the crude product, 2-bromo-3 methoxyaniline B4 (91 %; 0.79 g) as a pale yellow oil.
MS 201.8 (MH)+; Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 95%.
Step D
To a solution of 2-bromo-3-methoxyaniline B4 (0.79 g; 3.9 mmol) in MeOH (7.6 mL) was added dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate A3 (0.53 mL; 4.3 mmol) dropwise at 0°C (caution: reaction is exothermic!). The solution was heated overnight at reflux and worked-up. The MeOH was evaporated and the crude product dried under high vacuum to afford a red gum, purified by flash column chromatography (1:30 ultra pure silica gel, 230-400 mesh, 40-60 mm, 60 angstroms; 4:1 hexane/EtOAc) to afford adduct B5 (86 %; 1.16 g) as a pale yellow solid.
MS 344.0 (MH)+; Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 72%.
Step E
To a pre-heated sand bath at about 440°C(external temperature) was placed the diester adduct B5 (1.1 g; 3.16 mmol) in diphenyl ether (3.6 mL). The reaction was stirred between 230°C - 245°C (internal temperature; MeOH started evaporating off at about 215°C) for 7 min and subsequently cooled to room temperature. As the solution cooled the product crystallized from the reaction mixture. The resulting brown solid was filtered, washed with ether and dried under high vacuum to afford the crude bromoquinoline B6 product (74%; 0.74 g) as a brown solid. NMR revealed this product to be a mixture of about 1:1 tautomers. NMR (DMSO; 400 MHz) ok(1 :1 mixture of tautomers); MS 311.9 (MH)+; Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 96%.
EXAMPLE 3C
Synthesis of 2-carbomethoxy-8-chloro-4-hydroxy-7-methoxyquinoline (C6)
Figure imgf000043_0001
B1 C2 C3
Figure imgf000043_0002
Step A 2-Amino-3-nitrophenol B1 (5 g; 32.4 mmol) was dissolved in concentrated HCl (75 mL) and 1 ,4-dioxane (14.7 mL). The mixture was heated to 70°C until most of the solids were in solution. The reaction mixture was cooled to 0°C (ice bath), and sodium nitrite (2.23 g; 32.3 mmol) in H2O (5.4 mL) was added over a period of 3 hours to the brown solution. The temperature was maintained below 10°C during the addition and the stirring was continued for an additional 15 min at 0°C. This diazonium intermediate was poured into a solution of Cu(l)CI (3.8 g; 38.9 mmol) in H2O (18.5 mL) and cone. HCl (18.5 mL) at 0°C. The reaction was stirred for 15 min at 0°C, warmed to 60°C, and stirred for an additional 15 min The reaction mixture was then brought to room temperature, and left to stir overnight. The reaction mixture was transferred to a separatory funnel and extracted with ether (3X 150 mL). The organic layers were combined, washed with brine (1X), dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated to afford the crude product (5.83 g) as a red-brown oil. The crude material was purified by flash column chromatography (1 :25 ultra pure silica gel, 230-400 mesh, 40-60 mm, 60 angstroms; 3:1 hexane/EtOAcas the solvent) to afford pure 2-chloro-3-nitrophenol C2 (48%; 2.7 g) as an orange solid. MS 171.8 (MH)- : Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 96%. Relevant literature for the Sandmeyer Reaction: J. Med. Chem, 1982, 25(4), 446- 451.
Step B The nitrophenol starting material C2 (1.3 g; 7.49 mmol) was dissolved in DMF (10 mL) and to this solution was added ground cesium carbonate (2.92 g; 8.96 mmol), followed by Mel (1.4 mL; 22.5 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. The DMF was evaporated in vacυo and the residue taken up in ether (150 mL), washed with water (150 mL), brine (4x 100 mL), and then dried over (MgSO4>. The organic phase was filtered and evaporated to afford the crude 2- chloro-3-nitroanisole 03 (98%; 1.38 g) as an orange solid. Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 93%.
Step C 2-Chloro-3-nitroanisole C3 (1.38 g; 7.36 mmol) was dissolved in a mixture of glacial acetic acid (19 mL)/ethanol (19 mL). To this solution was added iron powder (1.64 g; 29.4 mmol). The mixture was stirred at reflux for 3.5 hr and worked up. The reaction mixture was diluted with water (70 mL), neutralized with solid Na2CO3 and the product extracted with CH2CI2(3X 150 mL). The extracts were combined and washed with saturated, brine and then dried over (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated in vacυo to afford the crude product, 2-chloro-3-methoxyaniline 04 (100%; 1.2 g) as a yellow oil. This material was used as such in the following steps. MS 157.9 (MH)+; Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 86%.
Step D
To a solution of 2-ch!oro-3-methoxyaniline 04 (1.2 g; 7.61 mmol) in MeOH (15 mL) was added dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate A3 (1.0 mL; 8.4 mmol) dropwise at 0°C (caution: reaction is exothermic!). The solution was heated overnight at reflux and worked-up. The MeOH was evaporated and the crude product dried under high vacuum to afford a red gum which was purified by flash column chromatography (1:30 ultra pure silica gel, 230-400 mesh, 40-60 mm, 60 angstroms; 4:1 hexane/EtOAc) to afford adduct C5 (74 %; 1.68 g) as a yellow solid. MS 300 (MH)+; Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 90%. Step E
To a pre-heated sand bath at about 440°C (external temperature) was placed the diester adduct 05 (1.68 g; 5.6 mmol) in diphenyl ether (6.3 mL). The reaction was stirred between 230°C - 245°C (internal temperature; MeOH started evaporating off at about 215°C) for 7 min and subsequently cooled to room temperature. As the solution cooled the product crystallized from the reaction mixture. The resulting brownish solid was filtered,' washed with ether and dried under high vacuum to afford the quinoline 06 (83%; 1.25 g) as a beige solid. NMR revealed this product to be a mixture of about 1:1 tautomers (keto/phenol forms). MS 267.9 (MH)+; Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 92%.
EXAMPLE 3D
Synthesis of 2-carbomethoxy-8-fluoro-4-hydroxy-7-methoxyquinoline (D5)
C
Figure imgf000045_0001
Step A
A solution of 2-fluoro-3-methoxy benzoic acid D1 (1.68 g, 9.87 mmol) and DIPEA (2.07 mL, 11.85 mmol, 1.2 equiv.) in a mixture of toluene (8 mL) and t-BuOH (8 mL) were stirred over activated 4A molecular sieves for 1 h followed by addition of diphenyl phosphoryl azide (DPPA, 2.55 mL, 11.85 mmol) and this mixture was refluxed overnight. Reaction mixture was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated in vacuo, the residue was taken in EtOAc (50 mL), washed with H2O (2x 30 mL) and brine(1x 30 mL). The organic phase was dried (MgSO4), filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude product D2 (2.38 g, 96%) was used as is in the following step. MS analysis shows the loss of Boc group: 141.9 ((M+H)-Boc)+, 139.9 ((M-H)-Boc)'.
Step B Compound D2 (2.28 g, 9.45 mmol) was treated with 4N HCI/dioxane solution (from Aldrich) (10 mL, 40 mmol) for 60 min and HPLC analysis showed that the starting material was fully consumed. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo, re- dissolved in EtOAc and washed with water, saturated NaHCO3 (aq), and saturated brine. The organic phase was dried (MgSO ), filtered and concentrated to give. 1.18 g (88%) of D3 as a brown oil, which was used as is in the following step. MS: 141.9 (M + H)+, 139.9 (M - H)-.
Step C Aniline D3 (1.18 g, 8.36 mmol) was combined with dimethylacetylene dicarboxylate A3 (1.45 mL, 10.0 mmol) in methanol (25 mL). The reaction was refluxed for 2 hours before being concentrated to dryness. The crude material was purified by flash chromatography eluting with 9/1 (hexane/EtOAc) to give the Michael adduct D4 as a yellow oil, (1.27 g, 54%).
Step D
The Michael adduct D4 was dissolved in warm diphenyl ether (6 mL) and placed in a sand bath previously heated to ~350°C. The internal temperature of the reaction was monitored and maintained at ~245°C for about 5 minutes (solution turns brown). After cooling to R.T., the desired 4-hydroxy'quinoline crashed out of solution. The brown solid was filtered and washed several times with diethyl ether to give, after drying, quinoline D5 as a brown solid (0.51 g, 45%). MS: 252 (M + H)+, 249.9 (M - H)-. Mixture of 1:1 tautomers, 1H-NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz) 12.04 (s, 1H), 1 .02 (s. 1 H), 8.0 (d, 1 H), 7.88 (d, 1 H), 7.65 (m, 1 H), 7.39 (s, 1 H), 7.32 (m, 1 H), 6.5 (s, 1 H), 4.0 (s, 3H), 3.98 (s, 3H), 3.95 (s, 3H), 3.91 (s, 3H).
EXAMPLE 3E
Figure imgf000047_0001
Step A
The amide E1 (5.0 g, 30.63 mmol) was dissolved in a mixture of acetic acid (5 mL) and sulfuric acid (10 mL) and cooled to 0°C. A mixture of nitric acid (70%, 3 mL) and sulfuric acid (2 mL) was added dropwise after which the solution was warmed to R.T. and stirred for 1 h. The reaction mixture was then poured onto crushed ice and filtered (after the ice had melted but the solution was still cold) to yield the desired compound E2 (5.8 g, 91%) which was carried forward to the next reaction without further purification. MS ES+ = 209.0, ES" = 206.9. (Ref: Giumanini, A.G.; Verardo, G.; Polana, M. J. Prak. Chem. 1988, 181).
Step B
Compound E2 (5.8 g, 27.86 mmol) was treated with 6M HCl solution (5 mL) in MeOH (10 L) and heated at reflux for 48 h to yield the desired product E3 (4.6 g, 99 %). RP-HPLC indicates full consumption of starting material (Rt (E2) = 2.6 min.; Rt (E3)= 3.9 min.). The mixture was concentrated and employed in subsequent reaction without further purification.
Step C Sulfuric acid (18 mL) was added to the solution of aniline E3 (4.20 g, 25.27 mmol) in water (36 mL) at 0°C followed by the addition of sodium nitrite (2.3 g, 33.33 mmol in water (6 mL). In a separate flask was placed a mixture of water (14 mL) and sulfuric acid (1.5 mL). This solution was brought to reflux and then the initial solution was added dropwise while maintaining a boil. After the addition was complete, boiling was continued for 5' min and the mixture then poured onto ice/sodium carbonate mixture while cooling in an ice bath. The product was extracted with aq. EtOAc and concentrated to yield a dark brown viscous liquid E4 (2.00 g, 47 %) which was employed in subsequent reaction without further purification. MS ES" = 210.9.
Step D
Mel (1.42 mL, 22.74 mmol) was added to a solution of the starting phenol E4 (1.9 g, 11.37 mmol) and potassium carbonate (2 g) in DMF (25 mL) at R.T. The mixture was heated at 50°C for 2 h and then cooled to R.T. EtOAc was added and the solution was washed with water (3x) and the aq. layer was then extracted with
EtOAc. The combined organic layers were dried, filtered and concentrated to yield the desired methyl ether E5 (2.0 g, 97%). 1H-NMR (CDCI3, 400 MHz) 7.62 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 1 H), 7.13 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 1H), 3.74 (s. 3H), 2.48 (s, 3H), 2.36 (s, 3H).
Step E
Ten percent (10%) Pd/C (200 mg) was added to a solution of nitro starting material E5 (2.0 g, 1 .04 mmol) in EtOH and placed on a Parr shaker under 40 psi H2 atmosphere for 2 h. The solution was filtered through a pad of silica/Celite, rinsed with MeOH and concentrated to yield the desired aniline E6 (1.5 g, 90 %) which was employed without further purification.
Step F
Aniline E6 (1.9 g, 12.65 mmol) was combined with dimethylacetylene dicarboxylate A3 (2.32 mL, 18.85 mmol) in methanol (3 mL). The reaction was heated at reflux for 2 h before being concentrated to dryness. The crude material was purified by flash chromatography (9:1 hexane/EtOAc) to give the Michael adduct E7 as a yellow oil (2.8 g, 76 %). H-NMR (CDCI3, 400 MHz) 9.48, (s, br, 1 H), 6.89 (d, J = 7.9 Hz, 1H), 6.47 (d, J = 7.9 Hz, 1 H), 5.35 (s, 1H), 3.74 (s. 3H), 3.70 (s, 3H), 3.65 (s, 3H) 2.27 (s, 3H), 2.24 (s, 3H). Step G
The Michael adduct E7 was dissolved in warm diphenyl ether (10 mL) and placed in a sand bath previously heated to ~350°C. The, internal temperature of the reaction was monitored, maintained at ~245°C for about 5 minutes (solution turns brown) and cooled to R.T. at which time the desired 4-hydroxyquinoline precipitated out of solution. The brown solid was filtered and washed several times with diethyl ether to give quinoline E8 as a yellow-brown solid after drying (1.10 g, 88 %). 1H-NMR (CHCI3, 400 MHz) 8.80, (s, br, 1 H), 8.06 (s, 1H), 7.26 (s, 1H), 6.93 (s, 1H), 4.04 (s. 3H), 3.80 (s, 3H), 2.45 (s, 3H) 2.39 (s, 3H).
EXAMPLE 3F
Synthesis of 2-carbomethoxy-4-hydroxy-7-methoxy-6-methyl quinoline (F4):
Step A
Figure imgf000049_0001
To a suspension of 2-methyl-5-nitroanisole F1 (1.54 g; 9.21 mmol) in absolute ethanol (15 mL) was added 10% Pd/C catalyst (249 mg). The suspension was hydrogenated under a hydrogen filled balloon at atmospheric pressure and room temperature for 6.5 h. The reaction mixture was filtered through a Millex 0.45 micron filter and evaporated to dryness to provide 4-methyl-n?-anisidine F2 (1.22 g; 8.89 mmol; 97 % yield)
Step B
Figure imgf000049_0002
F2 Dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate A3 (1.1 mL, 8.95 mmol) was added dropwise to a solution of 4-methyl- -anisidine F2 (1.22 g, 8.89 mmol) in MeOH (20 mL). Caution the reaction is exothermic. The mixture was heated at a gentle reflux for 4 hours, cooled and concentrated under vacuum. The crude material was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel with hexane : EtOAc (92.5 : 7.5) to provide, after evaporation. of the pure fractions, the diester adduct F3 (1.8 g; 6.44 mmol; 73 % yield).
Step C
Figure imgf000050_0001
The diester F3 (1.8 g, 6.44 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (5 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 350- 400°C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 240°C, a count of five minutes was begun before the bath was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature overnight. A solid formed upon cooling which was diluted with ether, filtered and dried to give a brown solid (0.97 g crude) containing both regioisomers in almost equal proportions. The crude material was triturated with MeOH and EtOAc, filtered and dried to provide the correct regioisomer of the methylquinoline product F4 as a yellow solid (245 mg, 15% yield).
Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 90%.
EXAMPLE 3G Synthesis of 2-carbomethoxy-4-hydroxy-[1!3]dioxolo[4,5-h]quinoHne (G5):
Step A
Figure imgf000050_0002
G1 G2
To a refluxing solution of commercially available 2,3-methylenedioxybenzoic acid G1 (485 mg; 2.92 mmol) in 1,4-dioxane (8.0 mL) and t-butanol (2.5 mL) was added TEA (430 μL; 3.08 mmol) and diphenylphosphoryl azide (DPPA, 630 μL; 2.92 mmol) and refluxed for 10 h. The mixture was evaporated, diluted with chloroform, washed with 5 % citric acid (3x), water, saturated sodium bicarbonate and brine, dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated to provide the crude product. Flash column purification on silica gel with hexane : EtOAc (75 : 25) provided the pure Boc-amino compound G2 (257 mg; 37%).
Step B
Figure imgf000051_0001
The Boc starting material G2 (257 mg; 1.08 mmol) was dissolved in 4M HCI/dioxane (5.0 mL) and stirred at room temperature for 1 hr. The solvent was evaporated and the residue diluted with saturated sodium bicarbonate (few mL) and 1 M NaOH (1 mL), extracted with EtOAc (2x), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated to dryness to provide the crude 2,3-methylene dioxyaniline G3 (158 mg; 106%,).
Step C
Figure imgf000051_0002
Dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate A3 (130 μL, 1.06 mmol) was added dropwise to a solution of crude 2,3-methylene dioxyaniline G3 (148 mg, 1.08 mmol) in MeOH (2.5 mL). Caution the reaction is exothermic. The mixture was heated at a gentle reflux for 3 hours, cooled and concentrated under vacuum. The crude material was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel with hexane : EtOAc (9 : 1 ) to provide, after evaporation of the pure fractions, the diester adduct G4 (185 mg; 0.662 mmol; 61% yield).
Step D
Figure imgf000051_0003
The diester G4 (180 mg, 0.645 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (2.5 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 350-400°C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 250°C (observe MeOH evolution at 220-230°C) a count of six minutes was begun before the bath (temperature end point :262°C) was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature. A solid formed upon cooling which was diluted with ether, filtered and dried to give the crude dioxyquinoline G5 (125 mg; 78 %). Purification was not required and the material was used as such in the following reactions. MS (M + H)+; 246, and (M - H)"; 248.1. Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm :88%.
EXAMPLE 3H
Synthesis of 2-carbomethoxy-4-hydroxy-8,9-dihydro-furo[2,3-h]quinoline (H7):
Step A
Figure imgf000052_0001
Triethylamine (5.0 mL, 35.6 mmol) was added to a flask containing the amine H1 (2.0 mL, 17.8 mmol) and dichioromethane (100 mL) under an atmosphere of nitrogen. The contents were cooled in an ice bath and trimethylacetylchloride (3.3 mL, 26.7 mmol) was added dropwise. The reaction was allowed to warm slowly to R.T. and stirred for 14 h. at this temperature. The reaction was quenched with NaHCO3 saturated solution and extracted with EtOAc. The combined organic layers were dried, filtered and concentrated followed by flash column chromatography (4:1 to 1:1 hexane:EtOAc) to yield the desired product H2 as an off-white solid (3.7 g, 97 % yield).
Step B
Figure imgf000052_0002
n-BuLi (15.9 mL, 1.6M, 25.5 mmol) was added dropwise to a flame dried flask containing a solution of the starting amide H2 (1.6 g, 7.72 mmol) in THF at 0°C under argon. Solution turned slight yellow/orange color when n-BuLi was added. The solution was allowed to warm slowly to R.T. and stirred for 24 h. The solution was again cooled to 0°C and ethylene oxide (0.46 mL, 9.26 mmol) was added dropwise. The solution was allowed to slowly warm to 23°C, quenched with NaHCO3 saturated solution, extracted with EtOAc, dried, filtered and concentrated followed by flash column chromatography (4:1 to 1 :1 hexane:ethyl acetate) to obtain the desired product H3 (1.94 g, 5.01 mmol, 65 % yield) Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm : 99%.
Step C
Figure imgf000053_0001
A BBr3 solution (26 mL, 1.0 M, 26.0 mmol) was added dropwise to methyl-ether H3 in CH2CI2 at 0°C. The solution was slowly warmed to 23°C and stirred for 14 h at R.T.. The reaction was quenched with M NaOH solution and extracted with EtOAc and CH2CI2 to obtain a mixture of desired product H4 and some uncyclized diol. Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm : 99%.
Step D
Figure imgf000053_0002
H4 H5 HCl (4.0 mL, 6.0M) was added to a solution of amide H4 (0.27 g, 1.22 mmol) in MeOH (4.0 mL) at 23°C. The reaction was then heated to reflux for 48 h, NaHCO3 (saturated, aq) was added and was extracted with EtOAc. The combined organic layers were dried, filtered and concentrated to obtain the desired aniline H5 which was of sufficient purity to employ in further transformations.
Step E
Figure imgf000054_0001
Dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate A3 (0.16 mL, 1.33 mmol) was added to solution of aniline H5 (0.18 g, 1.33 mmol) in MeOH (3.0 mL) at R.T. The solution was heated at reflux for 3 h., cooled to R.T. and a saturated NaCl solution was added. The mixture was extracted with EtOAc (3x) and the combined organic layers were then dried, filtered and concentrated followed by purification by flash column chromatography (9:1 to 1:1 hex:EtOAc) to afford the desired olefin H6 (0.29 g, 78%).
Step F
Figure imgf000054_0002
A flask containing starting olefin H6 (0.29 g, 1.04 mmol) in diphenyl ether (2.0 mL) was lowered into a pre-heated sand bath (350°C). When the internal temperature of the reaction reached 225°C, the flask was heated for 6-7 minutes during which time the internal temperature rose to 240°C. The reaction mixture was then removed from the sand bath and allowed to slowly cool to R.T. A precipitate formed upon standing. Diethyl ether was added and the solution was filtered and rinsed with additional diethyl ether to yield a light-brown solid H7 (0.20 g, 77%). MS 246.0 (MH)+.
EXAMPLE 3J Synthesis of 2-carbomethoxy-4-hydroxy-8-methyIthioquinoline (J3):
Step A
Figure imgf000054_0003
Dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate A3 (5.21 mL, 35.91 mmol) was added dropwise to a solution of 2-methylmercaptoaniline J1 (5.0 g, 35.91 mmol) in MeOH (100 mL). Caution the reaction is exothermic. The mixture was heated at a gentle reflux for 2 hours, cooled and concentrated under vacuum. The crude material was purified by flash column chromatography with hexane : EtOAc (90 :10) to provide, after evaporation of the pure fractions, the diester adduct J2 (10.53 g; 37.43 mmol; 99% yield).
Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm : 85%.
Figure imgf000055_0001
The diester J2 (10.53 g, 37.43 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (35 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 350-400°C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 245°C, a count of six minutes was begun before the bath was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature. A precipitate formed, which was suspended in ether, filtered and washed again with ether to provide the C8-SMe quinoline product J3 (6.15 g; 66%). MS (M + H)+; 250 Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 99%.
EXAMPLE 3K
Synthesis of 7-tert-butyloxy-2-carbomethoxy-4-hydroxy-8-methylquinoline (K6)
Step 1 :
Figure imgf000055_0002
To a solution of 2-methyl-3-nitrophenol K1 (1.1 g ; 7.18 mmol) in THF (13 mL) was added cyclohexane (27 mL; a solution was maintained). terf-Butyl trichloroacetimidate K2 (5.36 L ; 28.73 mmol) was added followed by a catalytic amount of boron trifluoride etherate (143.8 μL; 1.14 mmol) and the reaction was stirred at room temperature for 15 h. The reaction was incomplete (by analytical HPLC) and an additional amount of te/f-butyl trichloroacetimidate (1.4 mL ; 7.51 mmol) was added (reaction remains in solution). The reaction was complete after stirring at room temperature for 5 h. Solid sodium bicarbonate was added, and the mixture was filtered, rinsed with dichlormethane and evaporated to dryness to provide a white solid. The solid was triturated with dichloromethane, the white solid filtered and discarded (= trichloroacetimide). The filtrate was concentrated and loaded onto a flash column for purification (hexane : EtOAc 9 : 1) to provide the pure 2-methyl-3-terf-butoxynitrobenzene K3 (1.17 g ; 78%). Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220nm : 96% '
Step 2:
Figure imgf000056_0001
To a solution of 2-methyl-3~fer.-butoxynitrobenzene K3 (1.31 g; 6.26 mmol) in absolute ethanol (30 mL) was added 10% Pd/C catalyst (130 mg) . The solution was hydrogenated under a hydrogen filled balloon at atmospheric pressure and room temperature for 63 h. The reaction mixture was filtered through a Celite pad, rinsed with absolute EtOH and evaporated to dryness to provide 2-methyl-3-tert- butoxyaniline K4 (1.1 g ; 6.14 mmol ; 98% yield). M.S. 180 (M+H)+ . Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @220nm : 96%
Step 3:
Figure imgf000056_0002
Dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate A3 (749 μL, 5.97 mmol) was added dropwise to a solution of 2-methyl-3-te/f-butoxyaniline K4 (1.07, 5.97 mmol) in MeOH (14 mL). The mixture was heated at a gentle reflux for 2 hours, cooled and concentrated under vacuum. The crude material was purified by flash column chromatography with hexane : EtOAc (95 : 5 ) to provide, after evaporation of the pure fractions, the diester adduct (1.13 g ; 3.52 mmol ; 59% yield). M.S. 320.0 (M-H)" .322.1 (M+H)+. Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm : 92%.
Step 4:
Figure imgf000057_0001
The diester K5 (1.13 g, 3.52 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (3.0 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 400- 440°C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 230°C (observe MeOH evolution at 220°C) a count of six minutes was begun before the bath (temperature end point : 242°C) was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature. No solid formed upon cooling, therefore the crude mixture was flash purified with hexane : EtOAc (8 : 2 to remove the diphenyl ether , then, 4 : 6 to complete elution of the product) to provide the C7-O-te/ϊ-Bu,C8-Me quinoline K6 as a beige solid (838 mg ; 82%). MS 288.0 (M-H)" 290.0 (M+H)+ .Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm : 99%.
This quinoline moiety was used for the synthesis of compounds 1032 and 1033 of table 1. For the synthesis of compounds 1034, 1035, 1057 and 1058, also of table 1 , quinoline K6 was used. Conversion of the C7-fen!-butyl-ether group to an hydroxyl group was done by treatment of the final compound with 50% TFA in dichloromethane for 30 min. at 0°C then for 30 min. at R.T. , evaporated to dryness, diluted with water and lyophilized.
EXAMPLE 3L Synthesis of 2-carbomethoxy-4-hydroxy-8-methoxyquinoline (L3): Step A
Figure imgf000058_0001
Dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate A3 (5.5 mL, 44.74 mmol) was added dropwise to a solution of o-anisidine L1 (5.0 mL, 44.33 mmol) in MeOH (100 mL). Caution the reaction is exothermic. The mixture was heated at a gentle reflux for 5 hours, cooled and concentrated under vacuum. The crude material was purified by flash column chromatography with hexane : EtOAc (95 : 5 to 90 :10) to provide, after evaporation of the pure fractions, the diester adduct L2 (10 g; 37.70 mmol; 85% yield). Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm : 82%.
Figure imgf000058_0002
The diester L2 (10 g, 37.70 mmol) was dissolved in diphenyl ether (15 mL) and the reaction mixture placed into a pre-heated sand bath at a bath temperature of 350- 400°C. Once the reaction mixture attained an internal temperature of 240°C, a count of six minutes was begun before the bath was removed and the reaction allowed to cool to room temperature. No solid formed upon cooling, therefore, the crude mixture was flash column purified with hexane : EtOAc (6 : 4 to 5 : 5 to remove impurities, then, 2 : 8 to complete elution) to provide the C8-OMe quinoline product L3 (4.56 g; 52 %). MS (M - H)"; 231.9 Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 99%.
EXAMPLE 4
Preparation of Dipeptides
Synthesis of dipeptide 1
Figure imgf000059_0001
A mixture of Boc-hydroxyproline P2 (50.0 g, 216 mmol), vinyl-ACCA methyl ester P1 (42.25 g, 238 mmol, 1.1 equiv.), TBTU (76.36 g, 238 mmol, 1.1 equiv.) and DIPEA (113 mL, 649 mmol, 3 equiv.) in DMF (800 mL) was stirred at R.T. under a nitrogen atmosphere. After 3.5 h, the solvent was evaporated and the residue extracted with EtOAc. The extract was washed with hydrochloric acid (10%), saturated sodium bicarbonate and brine. The organic phase was then dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and evaporated to afford an oil. After drying overnight under high vacuum, dipeptide 1 was obtained as a yellow foam (72.0 g, 94%), purity >95% by HPLC).
Preparation of dipeptide 3
Figure imgf000059_0002
Dipeptide 1 (72.0 g, 203 mmol), triphenylphosphine (63.94 g, 243.8 mmol, 1.2 equiv.) and 4-nitrobenzoic acid (41.08 g, 245.8 mmol, 1.2 equiv) were dissolved in dry THF (1.4 L) The stirred solution was cooled to 0°C under a nitrogen atmosphere. Diethyl azodicarboxylate (38.4 mL, 244 mmol, 1.2 equiv.) was then added dropwise over 45 min and the reaction allowed to warm to R.T. After 4 h, the solvent was evaporated. The residue was divided into four portions. Each of these was purified by chromatography over fine silica gel (10-40 μm mesh, column diameter 12 cm, column length 16 cm) using a gradient of 2 :1 hexane/EtOAc to 1:1 hexane/EtOAc to pure EtOAc. In this manner, the Boc-dipeptide ester 2 was obtained as an amorphous white solid after evaporation of the solvents and drying of the residues under high vacuum at 70°C for 1 h (108.1 g, quantitative). A solution of 4N hydrogen chloride in dioxane was added to the Boc-dipeptide ester 2 (108 g, 243 mmol) resulting in a colorless solution. The solution was stirred at R.T. for 1 h. The solvent was evaporated and the residue placed under high vacuum for 3 h affording the hydrochloride salt of compound 3 as an amorphous solid. The solid was used as such.
EXAMPLE S
Preparation of Tripeptides
Synthesis of tripeptide 6a
Figure imgf000060_0001
Carbamate 4b (6.15 g, 22.5 mmol) and TBTU (7.72 g, 24.7 mmol) were suspended in DCM and the suspension was stirred rapidly. DIPEA (3.92 mL, 22.5 mmol) was added at R.T. and after 10 min, the reaction was nearly homogeneous. A solution of dipeptide 3 (10.39 g, 23.6 mmol) in anhydrous DCM (100 mL) containing DJPEA (4.11 mL, 23.62 mmol) was then poured into the reaction. The resulting yellow solution was allowed to stir for 14 h. The solvent was then evaporated yielding a yellow syrup which was extracted with EtOAc (300 + 50 mL) and washed with 0.05N HCl (2x 200 mL), saturated Na2CO3 (300 mL) and brine (150 mL). The combined extracts were dried over MgSO and evaporated to yield the tripeptide 6a as a pale yellow foam (15.68 g, quantitative).
Synthesis of tripeptide 7a:
Figure imgf000060_0002
The tripeptide 6a (15.68 g) was dissolved in THF (200 mL) and water (30 mL) was added. The resulting solution was cooled to 0°C and a solution of lithium hydroxide monohydrate (1.18 g, 28.12 mmol) was added over 3 min with vigorous stirring. After 3 h at 0°C, the excess base was neutralized with 1 N HCl (final pH ca. 6) and the THF evaporated, resulting in an aqueous suspension (yellow gum). The mixture was extracted with EtOAc (2x 200 mL) and washed with saturated NaHCO3 (2x 300 mL). The combined extracts were dried over MgSO4 and evaporated to yield a pale yellow foam. Flash chromatography of the foam over silica gel using EtOAc as eluent afforded 7a as a white amorphous solid (9.77 g, 91%).
Synthesis of tripeptide 6b
Figure imgf000061_0001
The cyclopentylurea-Tbg 5 (2.21 g, 9.10 mmol) and TBTU (3.12 g, 10.0 mmol) were dissolved/suspended in anhydrous dichloromethane (40 mL) and DiPEA (1 equiv.) was added. The reaction was stirred at ambient temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere until the solution became nearly homogeneous (ca. 10 min). A solution of P1-P2.dipeptide (4.20 g, 9.56 mmol) in anhydrous dichloromethane (35 mL containing 1 equiv. DIPEA) was then added to the reaction and the resulting yellow solution allowed to stir for 14 h after the reaction was rendered basic by the addition of DIPEA (ca. 1.5 mL). The solvent was evaporated yielding a yellow syrup which was extracted with ethyl acetate (150 + 50 mL) and washed with 0.1 HCl (150 mL), water (100 mL, emulsion broken with brine), saturated Na2CO3 (150 mL) and brine (100 mL). The combined extracts were then dried over MgSO4 and evaporated to a pale yellow solid 6b (6.21 g, HPLC purity 95%).
Synthesis of tripeptide 7b
Figure imgf000061_0002
The crude pNBz ester 6b prepared above was dissolved in THF (90 mL) and methanol (40 mL) added. 1.0N sodium hydroxide solution (12.0 mL; 12.0 mmol) was then added with vigorous stirring over 10 min (dropping funnel) and the hydrolysis allowed to proceed at ambient temperature. After 2 h, the excess base was neutralized by the careful addition of 1 N HCl (ca. 1.5 mL, added dropwise until the yellow color faded; final pH ca. 6). The organic solvents were evaporated and the aqueous residue was extracted with ethyl acetate (150 + 50 L) and washed with saturated sodium bicarbonate (3x 150 mL) and brine (100 mL). The combined extracts were dried over MgSO4 and evaporated to a pale yellow, amorphous solid which was dried under high vacuum 7b (4.11 g, 87% from the P3-urea, HPLC purity 93%).
Synthesis of Brosylate derivative 7aBrs
Figure imgf000062_0001
To a cooled solution (0°C) of the tripeptide (10 g; 20.85 mmol), brosy! chloride (11.19 g; 43.79 mmol) and dimethylaminopyridine (254 mg; 2.09 mmol) dissolved in dichloromethane (75 mL), triethylamine (10.2' mL; 72.98 mmol) was added dropwise. The yellow solution was stirred 1 hour at 0°C, then was slowly allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred 60 hours at room temperature. The reaction mixture was concentrated to dryness, diluted with EtOAc, washed with saturated sodium bicarbonate solution, water and brine, dried (MgSO ), filtered and evaporated to dryness to obtain the crude product The crude material was purified by flash column chromatography with hexane : EtOAc; 60 : 40 to 50 : 50 to provide the pure product 7aBrs as a white foam (11.66 g; 80%). M.S. 698 (M+H)+; 700.2 (MH+2)+. Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm: 99%.
EXAMPLE 6 Introduction of quinoline moieties into the tripeptides:
Synthesis of Intermediate 10a via brosylate displacement:
Figure imgf000063_0001
The brosylate 7aBrs (0.5 g; 0.71 mmol), bromoquinoline B6 (234 mg; 0.75 mmol) and ground cesium carbonate (56 mg; 0.78 mmol) were all dissolved in 1-methyl-2- pyrrolidinone (7.6 mL), and the solution was heated to 70°C and stirred for 7 h. The solution was subsequently cooled to room temperature and worked-up. The reaction mixture was poured into EtOAc, washed with H2O (1X), NaHCO3 (saturated; 2X), brine (5X), dried, filtered and concentrated to afford the crude product (0.565 g) as an off white solid. Purification by flash column chromatography (1:30 silica gel; 7:3 0 EtOAc/hexane) afforded " pure product 10a (77%; 0.429 g) as a white solid. MS 775.2 (M+2H)+. Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm : 96%.
Synthesis of Intermediate 10b via Mitsunobu reaction:
Figure imgf000063_0002
15
To the tripeptide 7a (1.55 g; 3.23 mmol) dissolved in THF (30 mL), the hydroxyquinoline A5 (1.08 g; 4.37 mmol) was added followed by 0.5 m triphenylphosphine silyl ester in THF (13 mL; 6.46 mmol). To the yellow suspension, was added dropwise the DIAD reagent (1.27 mL; 6.46 mmol) and stirred at room
20 temperature for 2 hours, worked-up by dropwise addition of 1 TBAF/THF solution (11.3 mL; 11.31 mmol) and stirred at room temperature overnight. By analytical HPLC, it is evident that the cleavage of the formed phosphine oxide by-product (to a water soluble moiety) is complete. The reaction was diluted with EtOAc, washed with saturated sodium bicarbonate solution (2x), water (2x), cold 1N NaOH (2x;
25. removes excess quinoline), water (2x) and brine (1x), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated to obtain a beige solid . The crude material was flash column purified with hexane : EtOAc (8 : 2) to obtain the product 10b as an ivory solid (1.92 g; 84%). M.S. 707.4 (M-H)' 709.4 (M+H)+. Homogeneity by HPLC (TFA) @ 220 nm : 94%.
EXAMPLE 7
Synthesis of Compound 1007:
Figure imgf000064_0001
Compound 1007 Step 1 : Selective monohydrolysis of ester 10b:
Figure imgf000064_0002
Tripeptide 10b (149 mg, 0.210 mmol), in 5 mL of a 1:1 mixture of THF-MeOH, was cooled to' 0°C for the addition of a 1 N NaOH aqueous solution (0.24 mL, 0.240 mmol). The resulting solution was stirred.15 min at 0°C, 1.5 h at R.T. and found to be incomplete by analytical HPLC. Additional 1 N NaOH (0.05 mL, 0.05 mmol) was added and the reaction stirred for an additional hour. The mixture was quenched with 1 M HCl, evaporated to near dryness, diluted with water, frozen and lyophilized to provide the acid 11b (crude material used for next step; assume 0.210 mmol). Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06% TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 89%. Step 2 : Synthesis of diazoketone 12b:
Figure imgf000065_0001
Sodium salt 11b (assume 0.210 mmol) was dissolved in THF (5 mL), triethylamine (75 μL; 0.538 mmol) was added and the solution cooled to 0°C. Isobutylchloroformate (45 μL; 0.346 mmol) was added dropwise and the white suspension was stirred at 0°C for 1 hour, followed by the addition of a solution of diazomethane (1M in diethyl ether; 1 mL; 0.999 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred 15 min at 0°C, 1 hour at R.T. and evaporated to provide a thick suspension. This suspension was dissolved in EtOAc, washed with saturated NaHCO3 (2x), brine (1x), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated to give the crude diazoketone product 12b (145 mg, 95%).
M.S.(electrospray) : 717.4 (M-H)" 719.4 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06% TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 85%.
Step 3: Synthesis of bromoketone 13b:
Figure imgf000065_0002
At 0°C, to a solution of diazoketone 12b (145 mg, 0.201 mmol) in THF (4 mL) was added dropwise an HBr solution (48% aq., 0.1 mL) and the mixture was stirred for 1.25 h. The mixture was quenched with a saturated NaHCO3 solution, then the THF was evaporated. The residue was diluted with EtOAc, washed with a saturated NaHCO3 solution(2x), brine (1x), dried (MgSO ), filtered and evaporated to provide the crude bromoketone 13b (139 mg, 89%). M.S.(electrospray) : 773.3 (MH+2)+ 771.3 (M+H)+ 769 (M-H)". Step 4: Synthesis of thiazolyl tripeptide 14b:
Figure imgf000066_0001
α-Bromoketone 13b (49 mg, 0.0635 mmol) and Λ/-neopentylthiourea 8a (12 mg; 0.0688 mmol) were dissolved in isopropanol (3 mL) and the yellow solution was heated at 75°C for 1 hour. The solution was allowed to cool to R.T. and evaporated to dryness. This crude material 14b was used for next step (assume 0.0635 mmol). M.S.(electrospray) : 845.5 (M-H)" 847.5 (M+H)+.
Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06% TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 69% (contain 16% of starting thiourea).
Step 5: Hydrolysis of ester 14b:
Figure imgf000066_0002
Compound 1007
To a solution of methyl ester 14b (53 mg, 0.0626 mmol), in a 3.5 mL mixture of THF:H2O (2.5:1), was added solid LiOH-monohydrate (27 mg, 0.643 mmol). 0.5 mL of MeOH was required to obtain an homogeneous solution. The resulting reaction was stirred at room temperature overnight. The organic solution was quenched with acetic acid and concentrated to provide an off white suspension. The crude material was purified by preparatory HPLC (YMC Combiscreen ODS-AQ, 50 x 20 mm ID S-5 micron, 120 A; λ= 220 nm) using a linear gradient and 0.06% TFA CH3CN / H2O . The pure fractions were combined, concentrated and lyophilized to provide the product 1007 as the TF salt (21 mg; 40% yield). 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca. 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 12.31 (br s, 1H), 8.56 (s, 1H), 8.20-8.08 (m, 1H), 8.05 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1H), 7:46 (br s, 1H), 7.30 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1H), 5.79-5.66 (m, 1H), 5.50-5.40 (m, 1H), 5.23-5.14 (m, 1H), 5.10-5.02 (m, 1H), 4.70-4.61 (m, 1H), 4.48-4.33 (m, 2H), 4.16-4.08 (m, 1H), 4.04-3.93 (m, 1H), 3.95 (s, 3H), 2.60 (s, 3H), 2.58-2.49 (m, 1H), 2.40 (br s, 2H), 2.32-2.21 (m,'1H), 2.08-1.98 (m, 1H), 1.80-1.22 (m, 10H), 1.04 (m, 9H), 0.97 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 831.5 (M-H)- 833.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %.
EXAMPLE 8
Synthesis of Compound 5005
Figure imgf000067_0001
Compound 5005
Step :
Figure imgf000067_0002
To a solution of the brosylate 7b Brs (1.89 g, 2.71 mmol) and quinoline F4 (670 mg,
2.71 mmol) in 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone (26 mL) was. added cesium carbonate (971 mg, 2.98 mmol) at ambient temperature. The reaction mixture was heated at 70°C for 12 hours, cooled to ambient temperature and diluted with EtOAc (100 mL), washed with water (2x 50 mL), saturated NaHCO3 solution containing 1 M NaOH
(1/5 of the volume) (50 mL) and brine (50 mL). The organic phase was dried over
MgSO , filtered and concentrated to afford the crude product as a yellow oil, which was purified by flash chromatography over silica gel column (250-400 Mesh), eluting with EtOAc/hexanes (13:7), to afford 1.27 g of a pale yellow solid (contaminated with 20% of starting quinoline). The solid was dissolved in THF (15 mL) and the suspension was treated with CH2N2 (5 mL) at R.T. for 12 hours, then concentrated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography over silica gel column (250-400 mesh) eluting with EtOAc/CHCI3 (12:6) to afford 0.9 g of pure 10c as a pale yellow foam (48%).
Step 2:
The conversion of the 2-carbomethoxy group of 10c into, the 2-(1-oxo-2-bromo)ethyl group of 13c was done using the reaction sequence described in example 7, steps 1, 2 and 3.
Step 3:
Reaction with thiourea derivative and final hydrolysis:
Figure imgf000068_0001
13c Compound 5005
To the solution of 13c (50 mg, 0.065 mmol) in isopropanol (3 mL) was added isopropylthiourea 8g (10 mg, 0.085 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at 70°C for 45 minutes. HPLC revealed complete consumption of the starting material. Cooled to ambient temperature and diluted with THF (2 mL) and 1.0N sodium hydroxide solution (0.325 mL). Stirred at ambient temperature for 12 hours, the reaction mixture was concentrated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in DMSO (2 mL) and the solution was injected onto a Combi-Prep HPLC column. The pure fractions were pooled and lyophilized to yield 26.1 mg of Compound 5005 as an amorphous yellow solid (trifluoroacetate salt) (50%yield).
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 8.60 and 8.82 (two s, 1H), 8.01-8.11 (m, 1H), 7.98 (s, 1H), 7.86 (s, 1H), 7.72 and 7.75 (two s, 1H), 5.90-6.03 (m, 1H), 5.80-5.90 (d, J= 16Hz, 1H), 5.62-5.79 (m, 2H), 5.15-5.26 (m, 1H), 4.96-5.13 (m, 1H),.4.44-4.61 (m, 2H), 4.16-4.23 (m, 2H), 4.08-4.13 (m, 2H), 3.98-4.01 (two s, 6H), 3.27 -3.38 (m, 1H), 2.53-2.70 (m, 1H), 2.32 and 2.36 (two s, 3H), 1.96-2.09 (q, J = 9 Hz, 17 Hz, 1H), 1.31-1.67 (m, 7H), 1.23-1.30 (m, 7H), 1.02-1.13 (m, 1H), 0.87 and 0.94 (two s, 9H).
EXAMPLE 9
Synthesis of Compound 4004
Figure imgf000069_0001
Compound 4004
Step l:
Figure imgf000069_0002
To a solution of brosylate 7a Brs (0.14 g, 0.20 mmol) and F4 (0.06 g, 0.24 mmol) in 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone (4 mL) was added cesium carbonate (0.08 g, 0.26 mmol). The mixture was heated to 70°C and stirred for 7 hr. The reaction mixture was cooled, poured into EtOAc (30 mL), washed with H2O (2X 50 mL), sat. NaHCO3 (2X 50 mL), and brine (3X 50 mL). The organic phase was dried, filtered and concentrated to a yellow oil. This material was purified by flash chromatography on a silica gel column (250-400 mesh) eluting with EtOAc/hexane (2:8), to afford 56 mg (40%o yield) of the product 10d as a pale yellow semi-solid.
Step 2: The conversion of the 2-carbomethoxy group of 10d into the 2-(1-oxo-2-bromo)ethyl group of 13d was done using the reaction sequence described in Example 7, steps 1, 2 and 3. Step 3:
Reaction with thiourea derivative and final hydrolysis:
Figure imgf000070_0001
13d Compound 4004
To a solution of bromoketone 13d (34 mg, 0.045 mmol) in isopropanol (2 mL) was added cyclopentylthiourea 8d (8.4 mg, 0.06 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at 70°C for 45 min, then concentrated to dryness and the residue was dissolved in a mixture of THF (1.5 mL) and methanol (0.3 mL). Water (0.45 mL) was added to this solution slowly with stirring, followed by LiOH (10.3 mg, 0.24 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at R.T. for 16 h. HPLC revealed that the reaction has proceeded to completion. The reaction mixture was concentrated, the residue was dissolved in DMSO and the solution was injected on to a Combi-prep HPLC column. The pure fractions were pooled and lyophilized to yield 16.5 mg (42% yield) of compound 4004 as an amorphous white solid (trifluoroacetic acid salt). 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) (mixture of rotamers;8:2): δ 8.59 and 8.71 (2s,1H), 8.13 (m,2H), 7.83-7.69 (m,2H), 7.1 (d, J=8.2Hz,0.8H), 6.46 (d, J=8.2Hz,0.2H), 5.76- 5.67 (m,2H), 5.21 and 5.17 (2s,1H). 5.05 (d, J=11Hz,1H), 4.53-4.49 (m,2H), 4.25 (br.s,1H), 4.04-3.99 (m,5H), 2.66-2.53 (m,1H), 2.34 (s,4H), 2.07-1.98 (m,3H), 1.76- 1.25 (m,16H), 0.95 and 0.87 (2s,9H).
EXAMPLE 10
Preparation of Dipeptides: Synthesis of Dipeptide 3:
Figure imgf000070_0002
To a solution of the brosylate 3 Brs(4.2 g, 7.32 mmol) and the quinoline A5 (1.45 g, 5.86 mmol) in 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone (25 mL) was added cesium carbonate (3.1 g, 9.5 mmol). The mixture was heated to 70°C for 12 h. The reaction mixture was poured into EtOAc (150 mL), washed with H2O (2X 150 mL), saturated solution of NaHCO3 (2X 150 mL) and brine (2X 150 mL). The organic phase was separated, dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to afford the crude product as a yellow oil. This material was purified by flash chromatography over silica gel column (250- 400 Mesh) eluting with 65% EtOAc in hexane to afford 15a (1.8 g, 42%) as a white solid.
EXAMPLE 11
Synthesis of Compound 2015
The synthesis was done according to the following sequence:
Figure imgf000071_0001
r- R = CH=0 E11-1 r- X = OMe E11-12 L-^ R = H: HCI E11-2 L- X = OH Compound 2015
E11-1: Potassium cyanide (1.43 g, 22.0 mmol) was added to a stirred solution of methylcyclopentanol (2.00 g, 20.0 mmol) in glacial acetic acid (1.00 mL) resulting in a thick slurry. To this was added, dropwise, sulfuric acid (3 mL, caution: exothermic) at a rate at which the temperature was maintained at ca. 30-35°C. Additional acetic acid (1 mL) was added to facilitate stirring of the thick paste. The mixture was then heated to 55-60°C for 30 min followed by stirring at ambient temperature for 16 h. Ice cold water (35 mL) was then added, the mixture extracted with ethyl ether (2x 40 mL) and the combined organic phases washed with 5% NaHCO3 (5x 30 mL), dried over MgSO4 and the solvent evaporated to yield a pale brown oil (1.16 g). The pH of the combined aqueous washings was then raised to pH 11 by the addition of solid K2CO3 and the resulting solids filtered and washed with ethyl ether (3x 40 mL). The filtrate was extracted with ethyl ether (2x 40 mL), the combined extracts dried over MgSO and the solvent evaporated to yield additional product (0.355 g) which was combined with the above obtained oil (1.52 g, 60 %).
E11-2: 5N Hydrochloric acid (8 mL) was added to a solution of E11-1 (1.50 g,
11.8 mmol) in dioxane (8.0 mL) resulting in some precipitation. Ethanol (4 mL) was then added and the solution heated to reflux for 4 h. The reaction was then cooled, the organic solvents evaporated and the aqueous residue washed with hexane (40 mL). The aqueous layer was then evaporated to dryness (ethanol was used to azeotrope the last traces of water) and the resulting solid was dried under high vacuum to yield the methylcyclopentylamine hydrochloride as a beige solid (1.38 g, 86%).
E11-3: To a stirred, ice cold solution of Boc-Tbg-OH (5.00 g, 21.6 mmol) in acetonitrile (75 mL) was added benzyl bromide (2.83 mL, 23.8 mmol) under an argon atmosphere. DBU (3.88 mL, 25.9 mmol) was then added in small portions over ca. 5 min. The resulting suspension was stirred at 0°C for a further 30 min then allowed to warm to ambient temperature. After 3 h, the solvent was evaporated and the residue extracted with ethyl acetate (50 mL), washed with 1 N HCl (2x 25 mL), 5% aq NaHCOg (3x 25 mL) and brine (25 mL), and then dried over MgSO4 and the solvent evaporated to yield the benzyl ester as a colorless oil (6.83 g, 98 %).
E11-4: The E11-3 (6.80 g, 21.2 mmol) was dissolved in dioxane (4 mL) and a solution of 4N HCl in dioxane (30 mL, 120 mmol) added. After stirring at ambient temperature for 2 h, the solvent was evaporated and the residue allowed to stand under a stream of nitrogen resulting in slow solidification. This material was then triturated with hexane (2x 50 mL), filtered, air dried for 30 min then placed under high vacuum for 5 days to afford the hydrochloride salt as a white solid (4.86 g, 89%).
E11-5: To a stirred, ice cold solution of E11-4 (4.85 g, 18.8 mmol) in tetrahydrofuran (75 mL) was added diisopropylethylamine (8.20 mL, 47.0 mmol) followed by the dropwise addition of phenylchloroformate (2.60 mL, 20.7 mmol) under an argon atmosphere. A thick precipitate formed which, upon vigorous stirring, became a fine suspension. After 4.5 h, the mixture was concentrated to. a third of its original volume and then extracted with ethyl acetate (50 mL) and washed with water (40 mL), 0.5 M KHSO4 (40 mL), 5 % NaHCO3 (2x 40 mL) and brine (50 mL). The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and evaporated to yield the phenyl carbamate as a colorless oil which slowly crystallized over a period of days (6.63 g, quantitative).
E11-6: To a solution of E11 -5 (1.00 g, 2.93 mmol) in DMSO (2.00 mL) containing acetonitrile (1.00 mL) was added diisopropylethylamine (817 μL) followed by the amine E11-2 (477 mg, 3.52 mmol). The reaction was stirred at ambient temperature for 2 h and then heated to 70°C for 45 min The solution was then diluted with ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with 5% aq K2CO3 (4x 50 mL) and brine (50 L). The ' organic phase was dried over MgSO4, the solvent evaporated and the residue purified by flash chromatography over TLC grade silica gel using 10:1 to 5:1 (gradient) hexane / ethyl acetate as eluent which afforded the urea E11-6 as a white crystalline solid (798 mg, 79%).
E 1-7: To solution of urea E11-6 (780 mg, 2.25 mmol) in absolute ethanol (10 mL) under an argon atmosphere was added 10% Pd-C. catalyst (100 mg). The system was purged three times with H2 and then stirred vigorously under a hydrogen- balloon. After 3 h, the catalyst was filtered over Celite and the filtrate evaporated. The residue was then dissolved in methanol (ca. 10 mL), filtered through a Millipore Millex 0.45 uM filter and then evaporated to yield the acid E11 -7 as a white solid (539 mg, 93%).
15b: The Boc-dipeptide 15a (1.23 g, 2.11 mmol) was dissolved in dry dioxane (2 mL) and a solution of 4N HCl in dioxane (10 mL, 40 mmol) added, resulting in a bright yellow solution which was allowed to stand at ambient temperature. After 3 h, the solvent was evaporated resulting in a gummy yellow solid which was triturated with dichloromethane (ca. 10 mL) and evaporated to a canary yellow powder which was dried under high vacuum (1.23 g,. quantitative).
E11-8: The urea E11-7 (239 mg, 0.932 mmol) and TBTU (3.06 mg, 0.979 mmol) were dissolved/suspended in anhydrous dichloromethane (4 mL) and diisopropylethylamine (157 μL, 0.900 mmol) added. The reaction was stirred at ambient temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere until the solution became nearly homogeneous (ca. 5 min). A solution of dipeptide 15b (494 mg, 0.888 mmol) in dichloromethane containing diisopropylethylamine (314 μL, 1.8 mmol) was then added and the resulting solution allowed to stir for 3 h after the reaction was rendered basic by the addition of additional diisopropylethylamine (ca. 0.15 mL). The solvent was evaporated yielding a yellow syrup which was extracted with ethyl acetate (2x 50 mL) and washed with saturated NaHCO3 (2x 50 mL) and brine (30 mL). The combined extracts were then dried over MgSO4 and evaporated to afford the tripeptide E11-8 as a fibrous white solid (650 mg, 97 %).
E11-9: The ester E11-8 (645 mg, 0.894 mmol) was dissolved in tetrahydrofuran (16 mL) containing methanol (8 mL) and 1.0N aqueous sodium hydroxide solution (900 mL, 0.900 mmol) then added dropwise with vigorous stirring at ambient temperature. After 5 h, the solution was evaporated (keeping the bath temperature below 30°C) and then placed under high vacuum overnight to afford the carboxylate salt as a pale yellow solid (725 mg, quantitative) which was used without further purification (ca. 10 % of diacid present).
E11-1Q: To a stirred, ice cold suspension of sodium salt E11-9 (0.894 mmol) in tetrahydrofuran (10 L) under an argon atmosphere was added triethylamine (240 μL, 1.72 mmol) followed by the dropwise addition of isobutyl chloroformate (174 μL, .34 mmol). The resulting suspension was stirred at 0CC for 3 h and a solution of diazomethane in ethyl ether (0.7M, 10 mL, 7 mmol) then added. The yellow suspension was stirred for 30 min at 0°C and then allowed to warm to ambient temperature. After 1 h, nitrogen was bubbled through the suspension for 5 min. to remove the excess diazomethane and the solvent evaporated. The residue was extracted with ethyl acetate (20 mL) and washed with 5% aqueous NaHCO3 (20 mL) and brine (20 mL). The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and evaporated to yield the diazoketone E11-10 as a yellow solid (626 mg (96%).
E11-11: To a stirred, ice cold solution of diazoketone E11-10 (620 mg, 0.850 mmol) in tetrahydrofuran (2 mL) was added dropwise 48 % aqueous hydrobromic acid (144 μL, 0.850 mmol) and the reaction stirred for 30 min The solution was then diluted and extracted with ethyl acetate (30 mL) and washed with 5% aqueous NaHCO3 (2x 20 mL) and brine (20 mL). The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and evaporated to afford the bromoketone E11-11 as a yellow solid (611 mg, 92 %).
E11-12: To a solution of bromoketone E11-11 (75 mg, 0.10 mmol) in isopropanol (0.30 mL) was added diisopropylethylamine (87 μL, 0.50 mmol) and N- acetylthiourea (18 mg, 0.15 mmol). The stirred mixture was heated to 70°C for 1 h and then extracted with ethyl acetate (30 mL) and washed with 5% aqueous
NaHCO3 (20 mL) and brine (20 mL). The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and evaporated to yield the crude aminothiazole as a yellow solid which was used without further purification.
Compound 2015: The ester E11-12 (0.10 mmol) was dissolved in tetrahydrofuran (0.80 mL) and methanol (0.25 mL) and 1.0 N lithium hydroxide (800 μL, 0.80 mmol) added. After stirring at arhbient temperature for 2.5, the organic solvents were evaporated and the resulting aqueous residue was diluted with DMSO (1 mL) and acetic acid (0.7 mL) and the solution injected onto a Combi-Prep HPLC column.. The pure fractions were pooled and lyophilized to yield the final inhibitor 2015 as an amorphous yellow solid (trifluoroacetate salt, 16 mg, 20 %): 1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 0.87 and 0.96 (two s, 9H), 1.19 and 1.28 (two s, 3H), 1.24-1.90 (m, 9H), 2.03 (app q4, Japp = 8.8 Hz, 1 H), 2.20 (s, 3H), 2.2-2.28 (m, 1 H), 2.60 (s, 3H), 3.83-4.05 (m, 2H), 3.93 (s, 3H), 4.19-4.23 (m, 2H), 4.36-4.46 (m, 3H), 4.81 (app t, Japp = 7 Hz, 0.2H), 5.03-5.07 (two sets of overlapping dd, 1H), 5.16-5.24 (two sets of overlapping dd, 1 H), 5.38 and 5.42 (two br. s, 1 H), 5.67-5.83 (m, 1 H), 5.95-6.04 (m, 2H), 7.26 (d, J = 9.4 Hz, 0.8H), 7.40 (d, J = 9.4 Hz, 0.2H), 7.43-7.55 (br. m, 1H), 7.89 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 0.2 H), 8.04 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 0.8H), 8.08 (br. s, 1H), 8.54 (s, 0.8H), 8.87 (s, 0.2H), 12.37 and 12.42 (two br. s, 1H). EXAMPLE 12
Synthesis of Compound 1038
Figure imgf000076_0001
Compound 1038
Using a reaction sequence similar to the one described in the last six steps of Example 11, but using carbamate 4c (Example 15) instead of urea 11-7, the following carbamate bromoketone E12-1 was prepared:
Figure imgf000076_0002
E12-1 Compound 1038
Conversion of the bromoketone to final compound was done as follows: To a solution of the bromoketone E12-1 (60 mg, 0.076 mmol) in isopropanol (3 mL) was added isopropylthiourea 8g (11.7 mg, 0.99 mmol). The reaction mixture was heated at 70°C for 45 minutes. HPLC revealed complete consumption of the starting material. The reaction mixture was cooled to ambient temperature, diluted with THF (3 mL) and 1.0N sodium hydroxide solution (1 mL) was added. After stirring at ambient temperature for 12 hours, the reaction mixture was concentrated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in DMSO (2 mL) and the solution was injected onto a Combi-Prep HPLC column. The pure fractions were pooled and lyophilized to yield 9 mg of Compound 1038 as an amorphous yellow solid (trifluoroacetate salt) (15% yield). 1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 12.35 (br s, 1H), 8.56 and 8.76 (two s, 1H), 7.72- 8.27 (m, 2H), 7.23-7.68 (m, 2H), 6.68-6.95 (d, J= 9Hz, 0.8H), 6.18-6.34 (d, J= 9Hz, 0.2H), 5.61-5.81 (m, 1 H), 5.52 (broad s, 1 H), 5.13-5.27 (m, 1H), 4.96-5.13 (m, 1 H), 4.31-4.50 (m, 3H), 3.74-4.17 (m, 8H), 2.53-2.60 (m, 3H), 2.20-2.36 (m, 1H), 1.95- 2.09 (m, 1 H), 1.70-1.91 (m, 2H), 1.95-2.09 (m, 1H), 1.37-1.61 , (m, 6H), 1.18-1.32 (m, 9H), 0.87 and 0.96 (two s, 9H).
EXAMPLE 13
Synthesis of Compound 2013
Figure imgf000077_0001
Compound 2013 Urea Acid E13-1: The urea-P3 acid was prepared from tert-butylamine and E11-5 by the same sequence of reactions as described in Example 11.
tripeptide ester E13-2: The urea-P3 acid was coupled with the P1-P2 fragment 15b as described in Example 11.
Compound 2013: The final inhibitor was prepared from E13-2 by a sequence of steps identical to that described in Example 1 . The product of the final saponification was isolated as an amorphous yellow powder (trifluoroacetate salt, 21 mg, 28 %). 1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 0.91 and 0.96 (two s, 9H), 1.15 and 1.21 (two s, 9H), 1.26 (dd, J = 5.0, 9.4 Hz, 0.8H), 1.53 (dd, J = 5.0, 7.8 Hz, 0.8H), 1.58 (dd, J = 4.3, 9.2 Hz, 0.2H), 2.03 (app q4, Japp = 8.8 Hz, 1 H), 2.20 (s, 3H), 2.2- 2.28 (m, 1H), 2.58 (s, 3H), 3.80-4.04 (m, 2H), 3.93 and 3.96 (two s, 3H), 4.18-4.20 (m, 2H), 4.35-4.45 (m, 3H), 4.83 (app t, Japp = 7 Hz, 0.2H), 5.03-5.07 (two sets of overlapping dd, H), 5.17-5.24 (two sets of overlapping dd, 1H), 5.36 and 5.42 (two br. s, 1H), 5.66-5.80 (m, 1H), 5.86-6.04 (br. m, 2H), 7.25 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 0.8H), 7.40 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 0.2H), 7.4-7.50 (br. m, IH), 7.88 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 0.2 H), 8.03-8.15 (br. m, 1.8H), 8.54 (s, 0.8H), 8.89 (s, 0.2H), 12.38 and 12.42 (two br. s, 1H).
EXAMPLE 14
Synthesis of compound 2018
Figure imgf000078_0001
Compound 2018
E14-2: The urea-P3 acid E14-2 was prepared from E11-5 and amine E14-1 by the same sequence of reactions as described in Example 11.
E14-3: The urea-P3 acid was coupled with the P1-P2 fragment 15b as described in Example 11.
The final inhibitor was prepared from E14-3 by a sequence of steps identical to that described on Example 11. The product of the final saponification was isolated as an amorphous yellow powder (trifluoroacetate salt, 10 mg, 21 %). 1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 0.74-0.97 (m, 21 H), 1.25 (dd, J=5, 9Hz, 1H), 1.47 (dd, J=8, 4Hz, 0.2H), 1.53 (dd, J=8, 5Hz, 0.8H), 2.02 (app q4, Japp=8Hz, 0.8H), 2.19 (s, 3H), 2.2-2.27 (m, 1H), 2.59 (s, 3H), 3.31-3.43 (m, 1H), 3.93 and 3.95 (two s, 3H), 3.98-4.02* (m), 4.22-4.26* (m), 4.35-4.39* (m), 4.82 (app t, Japp=7Hz, 0.2H), 5.01- 5.06 (two sets of overlapping dd, 1H), 5.16-5.23 (two sets of overlapping dd, 1H), 5.35 and 5.41 (two br. s, 1H), 5.67-5.79 (m, 1H), 5.87 (d, J=9.4Hz, 0.8H), 5.91 (d, J=9.4Hz, 0.2H), 6.07 (d, J=8.6H∑, 0.8H), 6.14 (d, J=9.2Hz, 0.2H), 7.24-7.5 (m, 2H), 7.89 (d, J=9.2Hz, 0.2H), 8.04-8.12 (m, 1.8H), 8.54 (s, 0.8H), 8.87 (s, 0.2H), 12.37 and 12.41 (two s, 1H). * obscured by HOD signal.
EXAMPLE 15 Permutation library:
Both bromo ketones 18a and 18b were used in a permutation library for the parallel synthesis of compounds as shown in the following scheme:
Figure imgf000079_0001
7- HPLC Purification
Step : Formation of the aminothiazole ring
A series of 8-mL vials were disposed in a reaction block from an ACT496 synthesizer (from Advanced Chemtech). In each vial was added the thio-derivative (8) of interest (0.0688 mmole), the bromoketone (0.0625 mmole) and isopropanol (500 μL). The closed vials were heated at 70°C for 1 h. The solvent was then evaporated using a vacuum centrifuge (SpeedVac) and was co-evaporated with 1 ,2- dichloroethane. The crude products were dried under high vacuum overnight.
Step 2: Removal of the Boc protecting group
All the vials were treated with 30% TFA in DCM (500 μL) for 1 h. All vials were transferred on a vacuum centrifuge to remove the volatile material. Step 3: Coupling
In each vial was added the corresponding carbamate (21c to 21 g) and carbamate acid (4b to 4k) (0.0875 mmole), HATU (0.0875 mmole, 33.27 mg) and DIPEA (0.313 mmole, 55 μL) in 500 μL of DMSO and the reaction mixture was allowed to proceed overnight.
J
Figure imgf000080_0001
Figure imgf000080_0002
4h 4i 4j
Figure imgf000080_0003
4k Step 4: Saponification and Purification
Ail reactions were diluted with 400 μL of DMSO and 200 μL THF. A solution of 500 μL of 2N aq LiOH (1 mmol) was added to each vial and allowed to proceed overnight after which time, the mixture was neutralized by the addition of 400 μL of AcOH. All compounds were purified by semi-prep reversed-phase HPLC (Symmetry column 5 cm x 19 cm, CH3CN / H2O 0.06% TFA gradient).
EXAMPLE 16
The following compounds were prepared using reaction sequences and methodologies as described in the above examples: Compounds from Table 1
Figure imgf000081_0001
Compound 1006 Compound 1006:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 12.31 (br s, 1H), 8.56 (s, 1H), 8.14 (br s, 1H), 8.06 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1H), 7.47 (br s, 1H), 7.34 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1H), 7.11 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 1H), 5.79-5.66 (m, 1H), 5.51-5.41 (m, 1H), 5.24-5.15 (m, 1H), 5.11-5.03 (m, 1H), 4.53-4.40 (m, 2H), 4.40- 4.32 (m, 1H), 4.07 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1H), 4.04-3.92 (m, 1H), 3.96 (s, 3H), 2.61 (s, 3H), .2.58-2.50 (m, 1H), 2.40 (br s, 2H), 2.31-2.17 (m, 1H), 2.12-1.95 (m, 3H), 1.91-1.76 (m, 2H), 1.71-1.39 (m, 3H), 1.31-1.23 (m, 1H), 1.04 (m, 9H), 0.97 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 817.4 (M-H)" 819.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000081_0002
Compound 1030 Compound 1030:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 8.56 (s, 1H), 8.14 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1H), 8.00-7.78 (m, 1H), 7.73-7.56 (m, 1H), 7.52 (s, 1H), 7.37 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1H), 6.97 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1H), 5.78-5.65 (m, 1H), 5.52-5.45 (m, 1H), 5.23-5.15 (m, 1H), 5.13-5.03 (m, 1H), 4.58-4.50 (m, 1H), 4.50-4.42 (m, 1 H), 4.39-4.31 (m, 1 H), 4.10-4.03 (m, 1 H), 4.01 (s, 3H), 3.99-3.70 (m, under H2O, 2H), 2.34-2.23 (m, 1H), 2.07-1.98 (m, 1 H), 1.70-1.37 (m, 9H), 1.34-1.23 (m, 2H), 1.26 (br d, J = 6.4 Hz, 6H), 0.96 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 839 (M-H)" 841.3 (M-H+2)" 841.3 (M+H)+ 843.3 (MH+2)+. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 98 %
Figure imgf000082_0001
Compound 1015 Compound 1015:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.32 (br s, 1 H), 8.57 (s, 1 H), 8.15-8.03 (m, 1 H), 8.04 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 7.47-7.37 (m, 1 H), 7.29 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1 H), 7.03 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1 H), 5.78-5.65 (m, 1H), 5.45-5.38 (m, 1 H), 5.23-5.14 (m, 1 H), 5.09-5.02 (m, 1 H), 4.72-4.62 (m, 1H), 4.46-4.32 (m, 2H), 4.16-4.08 (m, 1H), 4.03-3.90 (m, 1 H), 3.94 (s, 3H), 2.60 (s, 3H), 2.30-2.19 (m, 1H), 2.20 (s„3H), 2.06-1.97 (m, 1 H), 1.81-1.21 (m, 11 H), 0.97 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 775.4 (M-H)' 777.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000082_0002
Compound 1024 Compound 1024:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 12.31 (s, 1 H), 8.55 (s, 1 H), 8.20-8.05 (m, 1 H), 8.03 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 7.54-7.40 (m, 1H), 7.38 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1 H), 7.33 (d, J = 9.4 Hz, 1 H), 5.79-5.66 (m, 1 H), 5.49-5.41 (m, 1 H), 5.23-5.15 (m, 1H), 5.09-5.02 (m, 1 H), 4.77-3.85 (m, 8H), 3.95 (s, 3H), 2.60. (s, 3H), 2.58-2.47 (m, 1H), 2.43-2.36 (m, 2H), 2.31-2.20 (m, 1 H), 2.07-1.98 (m, 1H), 1.57-1.51 (m, 1H), 1.31-1.23 (m, 1H), 1.04 (s, 9H), 1.00 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 809.4 (M-H)" 811.4 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 98 %
Figure imgf000083_0001
Compound 1001 Compound 1001 : 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 7:3 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 8.01 (br s, 1 H), 7.92 (s, 1 H), 7.90-7.77 (m, 2H), 7.70 (br s, 1 H), 7.31 (d, J = 9.4 Hz, 1 H), 6.72 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1 H), 6.28-6.10 (m, 1H), 5.53-5.33 (m, 1 H), 5.03-5.92 (m, 1 H), 4.85-4.71 (m, 1 H),.4.49-4.40 (m, 1 H), 4.19-4.02 (m, 3H), 4.03 (s, 3H), 3.93 (s, 3H), 2.82-2.45 (m, 3H), 2.36-2.23 (m, 1H), 1.90-1.79 (m, 1 H), 1.34 (m, 9H), 1.37-1.14 (m, 2H), 1.03 (s, 9H), 0.98 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 835.4 (M-H)' 837.3 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000083_0002
Compound 1011 Compound 1011 :
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 8.53 (s, 1 H), 7.92 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1 H), 7.69 (d, J = 7.4 Hz, 1 H), 7.46 (s, 1H), 7.39 (s, 1 H), 7.25 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1 H), 6.99 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1 H), 5.79-5.64 (m, 1 H), 5.44-5.33 (m, 1 H), 5.23-5.13 (m, 1 H), 5.10-5.00 (m, 1 H), 4.81-4.70 (m, 1 H), 4.45-4.27 (m, 2H), 4.19-4.11 (m, 1 H), 4.04-3.91 (m, 1 H), 3.87-3.72 (m, 1 H), 2.75 (s, 6H), 2.66 (s, 3H), 2.56-2.42 (m, 1 H), 2.29-2.17 (m, 1 H), 2.07-1.97 (m, 1 H), 1.80-1.21 (m, 10H), 1.25 (br d, J = 6.5 Hz, 6H), 0.97 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 788.4 (M-H)" 790.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 95 %
Figure imgf000084_0001
Compound 1023 Compound 1023:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.36 (s, 1 H), 8.55 (s, 1 H), 8.09-7.97 (m, 2H), 7.42 (br s, 1 H), 7.29 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 6.99 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1H), 5.79-5.66 (m, 1 H), 5.45-5.38 (m, 1 H), 5.23- 5.15 (m, 1 H), 5.09-5.02 (m, 1 H), 4.75-4.66 (m, 1 H), 4.47-4.31 (m, 2H), 4.16-4.09 (m, 1 H), 4.03-3.91 (m, 1 H), 3.94 (s, 3H), 3.29-3.18 (m, 2H), 2.60-2.43 (m, 1 H), 2.30-2.18 (m, 1 H), 2.20 (s, 3H), 2.07-1.97 (m, 1 H), 1.81-1.33 (m, 9H), 1.31-1.23 (m, 1 H), 1.18 (t, J = 7.3 Hz, 3H), 0.97 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 789.3 (M-H)' 791.4 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 98 %
Figure imgf000085_0001
Compound 1033 Compound 1033:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 12.36 (s, 1H), 8.53 (s, 1H), 8.05 (s, 1H), 7.98 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1H), 7.46 (s, 1 H), 7.20 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1 H), 7.04 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 1 H), 5.80-5.65 (m, 1 H), 5.44- 5.37 (m, 1 H), 5.24-5.14 (m, 1 H), 5.10-5.01 (m, 1 H), 4.85-4.76 (m, 1H), 4.45-4.34 (m, 2H), 4.21-4.10 (m, 1 H), 4.04-3.89 (m, 1 H), 2.62 (s, 3H), 2.58-2.47 (m, 1 H), 2.28-2.18 (m, 1 H), 2.20 (s, 3H), 2.06-1.96 (m, 1 H), 1.81-1.38 (m, 9H), 1.39 (s, 9H), 1.29-1.22 (m, 1 H), 0.99 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 817.4 (M-H)" 819.4 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 98 %
Figure imgf000085_0002
Compound 1037 Compound 1037: 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 12.29 (s, 1H), 8.54 (s, 1H), 8.19-8.01 (m, 1H), 8.04 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1H), 7.44 (s, 1 H), 7.25 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 6.79 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 1 H), 5.78-5.65 (m, 1H), 5.47-5.37 (m, 1H), 5.22-5.13 (m, 1H), 5.08-5.02 (m, 1H), 4.45-4.33 (m, 2H), 4.13- 4.06 (m, 1 H), 3.98-3.90 (m, 1 H), 3.92 (s, 3H), 2.59 (s, 3H), 2.56-2.46 (m, 1 H), 2.41- 2.36 (m, 2H), 2.28-2.18 (m, 1 H), 2.05-1.96 (m, 1 H), 1.93-1.43 (m, 9H), 1.33 (br s, 3H), 1.29-1.22 (m, 1 H), 1.03 (s, 9H), 0.97 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 845.5 (M-H)' 847.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC
Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 96 %
Figure imgf000086_0001
Compound 1051
Compound 1051 :
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.35 (s, 1H), 8.54 (s, 1 H), 8.03 (s, 1H), 7.92 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 7.47 (s, 1 H), 7.38 (t, J = 8.3 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (d, J = 8.7 Hz, 1 H), 5.78-5.65 (m, 1H), 5.47- 5.38 (m, 1 H), 5.23-5.13 (r , 1 H), 5.09-5.00 (m, 1H), 4.69-4.60 (m, 1 H), 4.48-4.30 (m, 2H), 4.14-3.90 (m, 2H), 3.98 (s, 3H), 2.60-2.39 (m, 3H), 2.30-2.20 (m, 1H), 2.06-1.97 (m, 1H), 1.80-1.37 (m, 8H), 1.37-1.20 (m, 2H), 1.12 (t, J = 7.5 Hz, 3H), 0.96 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 793.3 (M-H)' 795.3 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 98 %
Figure imgf000086_0002
Compound 1053 Compound 1053:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 12.06 (br s, 1 H), 8.55 (s, 1 H), 8.12 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 8.05 (s, 1 H), 7.46 (m, 1 H), 7.39 (d, J = 9.3 Hz, 1 H), 6.98 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1 H), 5.78-5.66 (m, 1 H), 5.44-5.38 (m, 1H), 5.23-5.15 (m, 1H), 5.09-5.02 (m, 1H), 4.65-4.52 (m, 1H), 4.49- 4.32 (m, 2H), 4.12-4.05 (m, 1H), 4.01 (s, 3H), 3.99-3.91 (m, 1H), 3.78 (s, 3H), 2.60- 2.45 (m, 1H), 2.31-2.20 (m, 1H), 2.07-1.97 (m, 1H), 1.81-1.37 (m, 8H), 1.37-1.22 (m, 2H), 0.96 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 811.1 (M-H)' 813.2 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 96 %
Figure imgf000087_0001
Compound 1027 Compound 1027: 1HNMR(400MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 8.58 (s, 1H), 8.06 (d, J= 9Hz, 1H), 7.91, 7.89 ( 2s, 1H), 7.57 (brs, 1H), 7.40,7.38 (2s, 1H), 7.25 (d, J=9Hz, 1H), 5.57-5.68 (m, 1H), 5.55 (brs, 1H), 5.20 (d, J=16Hz, 1H), 5.06 (d, J= 11 Hz, 1H)), 4.69 (brs, 1H), 4.47 (t, J= 9Hz, 1H), 4.30-4.35 (m, 1H), 4.08 (d, J= 9Hz, 2H), 4.05-3.96 (m, 2H), 3.97 (s,3H), 3.66-3.40 (m, 8H), 2.56 (s, 3H), 2.35-2.25 (m, 1H), 2.08-1.98 (m, 1H), 1.60-1.50 (m, 2H), 1.28, 1.26 (2s, 6H), 0.97 (s, 9H). EIMS: (M+H) = 779.3, (M-H) = 777.3 Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99%.
Figure imgf000087_0002
Compound 1041 Compound 1041 : H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 12.33 (br s. 1 H), 8.55 (s, 1 H), 8.15-8.02 (m, 1 H), 8.04 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1H), 7.49-7.38 (m, 1 H), 7.29 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 6.99 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1 H), 5.78-5.66 (m, 1 H), 5.46-5.39 (m, 1H), 5.23-5.14 (m, 1 H), 5.09-5.02 (m, 1 H), 4.71-4.62 (m, 1 H), 4.47-4.32 (m, 2H), 4.15-4.09 (m, 1 H), 4.03-3.92 (m, 1 H), 3.94 (s, 3H), 2.60 (s, 3H), 2.58-2.40 (m, 2H), 2.30-2.20 (m, 1H), 2.07-1.97 (m, 1H), 1.80-1.21 (m, 11 H), 1.13 (t, J = 7.5 Hz, 3H), 0.97 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 789.4 (M-H)' 791.4 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 98 %.
Figure imgf000088_0001
Compound 1026 Compound 1026: H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 12.30 (s, 1 H), 8.56 (s, 1 H), 8.09 (br s, 1 H), 8.02 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1 H), 7.44 (br s, 1 H), 7.32 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 7.24 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1 H), 5.78-5.66 (m, 1 H), 5.47-5.39 (m, 1H), 5.23-5.15 (m, 1H), 5.10-5.03 (m, 1H), 4.80-4.72 (m, 1H), 4.49- 4.41 (m, 1 H), 4.37-4.29 (m, 1 H), 4.15-4.08 (m, 1 H), 4.05-3.95 (m, 1 H), 3.95 (s, 3H), 3.80-3.51 (m, under H2O, 4H), 2.60 (s, 3H), 2.57-2.48 (m, 1 H), 2.41-2.37 (m, 2H), 2.31-2.21 (m, 1 H), 2.07-1.98 (m, 1 H), 1.95-1.83 (m, 1 H), 1.62-1.46 (m, 2H), 1.31- 1.22 (m, 1 H), 1.04 (s, 9H), 0.97 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 833.3 (M-H)' 835.4 (M+H)+. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000089_0001
Compound 1022 Compound 1022:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.32 (s, 1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 8.08-7.97 (m, 2H), 7.42 (brs, 1H), 7.29 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1H), 5.79-5.66 (m, 1H), 5.44-5.37 (m, 1H), 5.24- 5.15 (m, 1H), 5.09-5.02 (m, 1H), 4.75-4.67 (m, 1H), 4.43-4.32 (m, 2H), 4.16-3.95 (m, 2H), 3.94 (s, 3H), 3.29-3.18 (m, 2H), 2.59-2.48 (m, 1H), 2.34-2.20 (m, 3H), 2.06-1.98 (m, 1H), 1.81-1.16 (m, 19H), 1.18 (t, J = 7.2 Hz, 3H), 0.97 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 857.4 (M-H)' 859.5 (M+H)+. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 98 %
Figure imgf000089_0002
Compound 1046 Compound 1046:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 11.91 (brs, 1H), 8.56 (s, 1H), 8.08 (brs, 1H), 8.04 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1H), 7.43 (s, 1H), 7.30 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1H), 5.78-5.66 (m, 1H), 5.46-5.38 (m, 1H), 5.23-5.15 (m, 1H), 5.09-5.03 (m, 1H), 5.03-4.93 (m, 1H), 4.71- 4.62 (m, 1H), 4.47-4.32 (m, 2H), 4.15-4.08 (m, 1H), 4.05-3.95 (m, 1H), 3.94 (s, 3H), 2.59 (s, 3H), 2.58-2.47 (m, 1H), 2.31-2.20 (m, 1H), 2.07-1.97 (m, 1H), 1.81-1.22 (m, 10H), 1.29 (d, J = 6.3 Hz, 6H), 0.97 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 819.4 (M-H)" 821.4 (M+H)+. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000090_0001
Compound 1036 Compound 1036: H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.35 (s, 1 H), 8.53 (s, 1 H), 8.12-7.98 (m, 2H), 7.41 (s, 1 H), 7.24 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1H), 6.79 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 1H), 5.78-5.64 (m, 1 H), 5.44-5.34 (m, 1H), 5.22- 5.13 (m, 1H), 5.08-5.01 (m, 1 H), 4.46-4.33 (m, 2H), 4.15-4.06 (m, 1 H), 4.04-3.95 (m, 1 H), 3.92 (s, 3H), 2.59 (s, 3H), 2.57-2.47 (m, 1 H), 2.28-2.17 (m, 1 H), 2.19 (s, 3H), 2.06-1.96 (m, 1 H), 1.94-1.77 (m, 2H), 1.72-1.43 (m, 7H), 1.34 (s, 3H), 1.29-1.21 (m, 1 H), 0.97 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 789.4 (M-H)' 791.4 (M+H)+. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 95 %
Figure imgf000090_0002
Compound 1056 Compound 1056:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.35 (s, 1 H), 8.55 (s, 1 H), 8.17 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 8.05 (s, 1 H), 7.47 (s, 1 H), 7.35 (d, J = 9.4 Hz, 1 H), 6.98 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1 H), 5.78-5.66 (m, 1 H), 5.46- 5.40 (m, 1H), 5.23-5.15 (m, 1H), 5.09-5.03 (m, 1H), 4.63-4.56 (m, 1H), 4.49-4.34 (m, 2H), 4.13-3.90 (m, under H2O, 2H), 4.01 (s, 3H), 2.60-2.51 (m, 1H), 2.49-2.43 (m, 2H), 2.32-2.21 (m, 1H), 2.07-1.98 (m, 1H), 1.81-1.37 (m, 9H), 1.36-1.16 (m, 3H), 0.96 (s, 9H), 0.93 (t, J = 7.4 Hz, 3H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 869.1 (M-H)' 871.1 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 98 %
Figure imgf000091_0001
Compound 1181 Compound 1181: 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 8.57 (s, 1H), 8.2-7.96 (m, 1H), 7.88-7.70 (m, 2H), 7.62-7.35 (m, 2H), 7.02 (d, J = 7.2 Hz, 1H), 5.78-5.65 (m, 1H), 5.65-5.55 (m, 1H), 5.19 (d, J= 17.2 Hz, 1H), 5.065 (d, J= 11.9 Hz, 1H), 4.63-4.52 (m, 1H), 4.50-4.40 (m, 1H), 4.13-4.08 (m, 2H), 4.06 (s, 3H), 3.98 (bd, J = 10 Hz, 1H), 3.92-3.80 (m, 1H), 2.62-2.53 (m, 1H), 2.38-2.27 (m, 1H), 2.02 (dd, J= 8.6, 8.6 Hz, 1H), 1.69-1.52 (m, 6H), 1.51-1.41 (m, 3H), 1.40-1.31 (m, 1H), 1.27 (d, J = 6.5 Hz, 6H), 0.97 (s, 9H). MS (electrospray): (M+Hf; 763.4 and (M-H)' 761.3. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99%.
Compounds from Table 2
Figure imgf000091_0002
Compound 2010 Compound 2010:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 8:2 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 8.56 (s, 1H), 8.41 (br s, 1H), 8.04 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1H), 7.55 (s, 1H), 7.29 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 6.09-5.99 (m, 1 H), 5.97-5.88 (m, 1 H), 5.78-5.65 (m, 1 H), 5.54-5.48 (m, 1 H), 5.23-5.15 (m, 1 H), 5.09-5.02 (m, 1 H), 4.47-4.33 (m, 2H), 4.27- 4.20 (m, 1 H), 4.19-3.85 (m, under H2O, 2H), 3.94 (s, 3H), 3.13 (q, J = 7.5 Hz, 2H), 2.60 (s, 3H), 2.55-2.42 (m, 1H), 2.34-2.23 (m, 1 H), 2.09-2.00 (m, 1 H), 1.80-1.37 (m, 7H), 1.40 (t, J = 7.5 Hz, 3H), 1.31-1.05 (m, 3H), 0.96 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 745.4 (M-H)' 747.4 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 96 %
Figure imgf000092_0001
Compound 2012 Compound 2012:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 8:2 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.29 (s. 1H), 8.54 (s. 1 H). 8.08 (br s. 1 H), 8.04 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1 H), 7.44 (br s, 1 H), 7.25 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1H), 6.08-5.90 (m, 2H), 5.80-5.65 (m, 1H), 5.45- 5.37 (m, 1 H), 5.22-5.13 (m, 1 H), 5.09-5.02 (m, 1 H), 4.48-4.34 (m, 2H), 4.26-4.19 (m, 1 H), 4.04-3.90 (m, 1 H), 3.93 (s, 3H), 2.60 (s, 3H), 2.68-2.57 (m, 1 H), 2.42-2.35 (m, 2H), 2.28-2.18 (m, 1 H), 2.08-1.98 (m, 1 H), 1.81-1.21 (m, 10H), 1.19 (s, 3H), 1.04 (s, 9H), 0.96 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 844.5 (M-H)" 846.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000093_0001
Compound 2002 Compound 2002:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 8:2 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 8.57 (s, 1 H), 8.28-7.77 (m, 3H), 7.66-7.30 (m, 2H), 6.09-5.98 (m, 1 H), 5.96-5.86 (m, 1H), 5.78-5.66 (m, 1H), 5.61-5.48 (m, 1H), 5.26-5.15 (m, 1H), 5.11- 5.03 (m, 1 H), 4.53-4.39 (m, 2H), 4.25-4.15 (m, 1 H), 4.05-3.93 (m, 1 H), 3.97 (s, 3H), 3.92-3.50 (m, under H2O, 2H), 2.55 (s, 3H), 2.59-2.42 (m, 1H), 2.36-2.26 (m, 1H), 2.18-1.99 (m, 1 H), 1.80-1.36 (m, 7H), 1.27 (d, J = 6.3 Hz, 6H), 1.31-1.05 (m, 3H), 0.95 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 774.4 (M-H)" 776.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 94 %
Figure imgf000093_0002
Compound 2007 Compound 2007: 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 8:2 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.38 (s, 1 H), 8.55 (s, 1 H), 8.09 (br s, 1 H), 8.06 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 7.44 (s, 1 H), 7.28 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 6.12-6.01 (m, 1 H), 5.98-5.89 (m, 1 H), 5.78- 5.66 (m, 1 H), 5.46-5.38 (m, 1 H), 5.23-5.15 (m, 1 H), 5.10-5.01 (m, 1 H), 4.47-4.36 (m, 2H), 4.28-4.20 (m, 1 H), 4.04-3.92 (m, 1 H), 3.94 (s, 3H), 3.90-3.50 (m, under H2O, 1 H), 2.60 (s, 3H), 2.55-2.47 (m, 1 H), 2.31-2.22 (m, 1 H), 2.20 (s, 3H), 2.08-1.99 (m, 1 H), 1.81-1.38 (m, 7H), 1.31-1.09 (m, 3H), 0.96 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 774.4 (M-H)" 776.4 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 94 %
Figure imgf000094_0001
Compound 2008
Compound 2008:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 8:2 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 12.34 (br s. 1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 8.17-8.05 (m, 1H), 8.07 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 7.50-7.42 (m, 1 H), 7.28 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 6.11-6.01 (m, 1 H), 5.98-5.88 (m, 1H), 5.78-5.66 (m, 1H), 5.46-5.38 (m, 1H), 5.24-5.14 (m, 1H), 5.10-5.01 (m, 1H), 4.48-4.36 (m, 2H), 4.28-4.20 (m, 1 H), 4.07-3.95 (m, 1 H), 3.94 (s, 3H), 3.80-3.65 (m, under H2O, 1 H), 2.60 (s, 3H), 2.60-2.50 (m, 1 H), 2.31-2.20 (m, 2H), 2.08-1.98 (m, 1H), 1.82-1.37 (m, 15H), 1.31-1.07 (m, 5H), 0.96 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 842.5 (M-H)" 844.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 97 %
Compounds from Table 3
Figure imgf000094_0002
Compound 3002 Compound 3002: ' 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-de): ca. 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 12.33 (s, 1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 7.98 (s, 1 H), 7.75 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1H), 7.40 (s, 1 H), 7.19 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1 H), 6.99 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1 H), 6.26 (s, 2H), 5.79-5.66 (m, 1 H), 5.46-5.38 (m, 1 H), 5.23-5.14 (m, 1 H), 5.10-5.01 (m, 1 H), 4.76-4.67 (m, 1 H), 4.47-4.30 (m, 2H), 4.11 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1H), 4.00-3.91 (m, 1H), 2.41-2.36 (m, 2H), 2.29-2.19 (m, 1H), 2.08-1.97 (m, 1 H), 1.82-1.22 (m, 11 H), 1.03 (s, 9H), 0.96 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 831.5 (M-H)" 833.6 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000095_0001
Compound 3007 Compound 3007:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 8.56 (s, 1 H), 8.04 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1 H), 7.94-7.64 (m, 3H), 7.49-7.37 (m, 1 H), 7.09 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 1 H), 7.00 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1 H), 5.80-5.66 (m, 1 H), 5.58-5.46 (m, 1H), 5.24-5.14 (m, 1H), 5.11-5.01 (m, 1H), 4.85-4.70 (m, 2H), 4.69-4.58 (m, 1H), 4.49-4.81 (m, 2H), 4.09 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1 H), 4.00-3.88 (m, 1 H), 3.75-3.30 (m, under H2O, 2H), 2.35-2.22 (m, 1 H), 2.07-1.97 (m, 1 H), 1.81-1.20 (m, 11 H), 0.97 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 731.3 (M-H)" 733.3 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 94 %
Figure imgf000095_0002
Compound 3010 Compound 3010:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.37 (s, 1H), 8.56 (s, 1H), 8.13-7.96 (m, 2H), 7.43 (s, 1H), 7.05 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1H), 7.00 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1H), 5.80-5.64 (m, 1H), 5.50-5.37 (m, 1H), 5.24- 5.11 (m, 1H), 5.10-4.98 (m, 1H), 4.83-4.63 (m, 3H), 4.47-4.30 (m, 2H), 4.19-4.05 (m, 1H), 4.04-3.86 (m, 1H), 3.75-3.30 (m, under H2O, 2H), 2.34-2.19 (m, 3H), 2.07-1.97 (m, 1H), 1.82-1.13 (m, 20H), 0.97 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 841.3 (M-H)" 843.4 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000096_0001
Compound 3001 Compound 3001:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 8.55 (s, 1H), 7.95-7.76 (m, 1H), 7.72 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1H), 7.49 (s, 1H), 7.41 (s, 1H), 7.18 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1H), 6.25 (s, 2H), 5.80- 5.65 (m, 1H), 5.52-5.46 (m, 1H), 5.24-5.14 (m, 1H), 5.10-5.01 (m, 1H), 4.75-4.66 (m, 1H), 4.48-4.39 (m, 1H), 4.37-4.27 (m, 1H), 4.17-4.07 (m, 1H), 4.01-3.92 (m, 1H), 3.90-3.75 (m, 1H), 2.62-2.44 (m, 1H), 2.31-2.20 (m, 1H), 2.09-1.97 (m, 1H), 1.81- 1.20 (m, 10H), 1.25 (brd, J = 6.4 Hz, 6H), 0.96 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 775.5 (M-H)" 777.6 (M+H)+. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000097_0001
Compound 3004 Compound 3004:
Mixture of rotamers (approx. 85:15), 1H NMR of major rotamer given (400 MHz, DMSO-de): δ 8.57 (s, 1 H); 8.10 - 8.13 (m, 1 H); 8.08 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1 H) 7.86 - 7.88 (m, 2H); 7.53 (s, 1H); 7.14 (d, J = 8.5 Hz, 1H); 7.00 (d, J = 8.5, 1 H); 5.68 - 5.78 (m, 1H); 5.57 (s, 1 H); 5.19 (d, J = 17.0 Hz, 1H); 5.07 (d, J = 11.9 Hz, 1 H); 4.78 - 4.82 (m , 2H); 4.58 - 4.63 (m, 1 H); 4.35 - 4.47 (m, 2H); 3.87 - 4.08 (m, 8H); 3.58 - 3.62 (m, 2H); 2.53 - 2.56 (m, 1 H); 2.27 - 2.33 (m, 1 H); 1.99 - 2.04 (m, 1 H); 1.43 - 1.65 (m, 4H); 1.28 - 1.30 (m, 1H); 1.26 (d, J = 6.2 Hz, 6H); 0.96 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 775.4 (M+H)+, 773.4 (M-H)".
Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 98.8 % '
Compounds from Table 4
Figure imgf000097_0002
Compound 4005 Compound 4005:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 12.36 (br s, 1 H), 8.57 (s, 1 H), 8.60-8.20 (m, 1 H), 7.90 (s, 1H), 7.68-
7.45 (m, 2H), 6.99 (d, J = 8.3 Hz, 1H), 5.78-5.66 (m, 1 H), 5.66-5.83 (m, 1H), 5.80-
5.50 (m, 1H), 5.23-5.14 (m, 1H), 5.10-5.01 (m, 1H), 4.62-4.36 (m, 3H), 4.11-3.92 (m, 1H), 2.88 (s, 6H), 2.62-2.51 (m, 1H), 2.47 (s, 3H), 2.44-2.38 (m, 2H), 2.36-2.19 (m, 1 H), 2.08-1.96 (m, 1H), 1.81-1.20 (m, 10H), 1.03 (s, 9H), 0.96 (s, 9H). M.S.(efectrospray) : 844.4 (M-H)" 846.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000098_0001
Compound 4007
Compound 4007: H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description: δ 8.59 (s, 1 H), 8.27-8.12 (m, 1 H), 8.06-7.97 (m, 1H), 7.89 (s, 1 H), 7.73 (s, 1H), 7.64 (s, 1 H), 6.99 (d, J = 8.5 Hz, 1 H), 5.79-5.64 (m, 2H), 5.24-5.14 (m, 1H), 5.10-5.01 (m, 1 H), 4.54-4.38 (m, 2H), 4.23-4.08 (m, 1H), 4.02 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 1H), 4.00-3.91 (m, 1 H), 3.70-3.30 (m, under H2O, 1 H), 2.90 (s, 6H), 2.64-2.52 (m, 1 H), 2.46 (s, 3H), 2.38-2.26 (m, 1H), 2.07-1.96 (m, 1H), 1.81-1.20 (m, 10H), 1.24 (br d, J = 6.5 Hz, 6H), 0.95 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 788.4 (M-H)" 790.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 98 %
Figure imgf000098_0002
Compound 4014 Compound 4014:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 8.61 (s, 1 H), 8.33-7.60 (m, 4H), 7.33 (s, 1 H), 6.95 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 1 H), 5.79-5.67 (m, 2H), 5.24-5.16 (m, 1H), 5.10-5.03 (m, 1H), 4.57-4.32 (m, 2H), 4.20- 3.88 (m, 3H), 3.99 (s, 3H), 3.93 (s, 3H), 3.65-3.30 (m, under H2O, 1 H), 2.65-2.55 (m, 1H), 2.40-2.28 (m, 1H), 2.08-1.98 (m, 1H), 1.81-1.21 (m, 10H), 1.25 (br d, J = 6.5 Hz, 6H), 0.95 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 791.3 (M-H)" 793.4 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 86 %
Figure imgf000099_0001
Compound 4001 Compound 4001 : 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.40 (s, 1H), 8.58 (s, 1H), 8.50-8.20 (m, 1H), 7.95 (br s, 1H), 7.72- 7.44 (m, 2H), 7.00 (d, J = 8.2 Hz, 1 H), 5.80-5.67 (m, 1 H), 5.67-5.51 (m, 1 H), 5.24- 5.14 (m, 1H), 5.12-5.02 (m, 1H), 4.63-4.45 (m, 2H), 4.45-4.36 (m, 1H), 4.14-3.93 (m, 2H), 3.99 (s, 3H), 2.64-2.46 (m, 1 H), 2.45-2.39 (m, 2H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.39-2.28 (m, 1 H), 2.08-1.98 (m, 1 H), 1.82-1.23 (m, 10H), 1.04 (s, 9H), 0.97 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 831.4 (M-H)" 833.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000099_0002
Compound 4013 Compound 4013:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.36 (s, 1 H), 8.59 (s, 1 H), 8.36-7.96 (m, 1 H), 7.70-7.42 (m, 2H), 7.32 (s, 1H), 6.94 (d, J = 8.2 Hz, 1 H), 5.79-5.66 (m, 1H), 5.63-5.50 (m, 1 H), 5.23-5.15 (m, 1 H), 5.10-5.02 (m, 1H), 4.58-4.45 (m, 2H), 4.38-4.28 (m, 1H), 4.12-3.90 (m, 2H), 3.97 (s, 3H), 3.91 (s, 3H), 2.62-2.52 (m, 1 H), 2.37-2.21 (m, 3H), 2.08-1.98 (m, 1 H), 1.77-1.14 (m, 19H), 0.97 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 859.4 (M-H)' 861.4 (M+H)+. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 92 %
Compounds from Table 5
Figure imgf000100_0001
Compound 5001 Compound 5001 :
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 8.60 (s, 1 H), 8.34-8.19 (m, 1H), 8.04-7.98 (m, 1H), 7.97 (s, 1 H), 7.91- 7.81 (m, 1 H), 7.73 (s, 1 H), 5.99-5.91 (m, 1 H), 5.90-5.83 (m, 1 H), 5.78-5.66 (m, 2H), 5.25-5.15 (m, 1H), 5.11-5.04 (m, 1H), 4.58-4.46 (m, 2H), 4.15-4.07 (m, 1H), 4.00 (s, 3H), 4.03-3.94 (m, 1 H), 3.60-3.15 (m, under H2O, 1 H), 3.05 (d, J = 4.3 Hz, 3H), 2.63-2.55 (m, 1 H), 2.42-2.30 (m, 1 H), 2.35 (m, 3H), 2.08-1.99 (m, 1 H), 1.80-1.22 (m, 9H), 1.13-1.03 (m, 1H), 0.94 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 746.3 (M-H)" 748.4 (M+H)+. Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000101_0001
Compound 5002 Compound 5002:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 8:2 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.44 (s, 1H), 8.59 (s, 1 H), 8.52-8.25 (m, 1 H), 7.97 (s, 1 H), 7.70-7.46 (m, 2H), 6.03-5.96 (m, 1 H), 5:90 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1 H), 5.79-5.66 (m, 1 H), 5.64-5.54 (m, 1 H), 5.24-5.16 (m, 1H), 5.11-5.04 (m, 1 H), 4.55-4.43 (m, 2H), 4.19-4.12 (m, 1 H), 4.05-3.94 (m, 1H), 3.99 (s, 3H), 3.80-3.30 (m, under H2O, 1H), 2.68-2.54 (m, 1H), 2.39-2.28 (m, 1 H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.23 (s, 3H), 2.08-1.99 (m, 1 H), 1.80-1.21 (m, 8H), 1.17-1.07 (m, 1H), 1.06-0.95 (m, 1H), 0.95 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 774.4 (M-H)" 776.4 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 99 %
Figure imgf000101_0002
Compound 5004 Compound 5004: 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 8.60 (s, 1 H), 8.31-8.16 (m, 1 H),.8.11-8.02 (m, 1 H), 7.97 (s, 1 H), 7.89- 7.78 (m, 1H), 7.75-7.67 (m, 1H), 6.00-5.92 (m, 1H), 5.90-5.83 (m, 1H), 5.80-5.65 (m, 2H), 5.26-5.16 (m, 1 H), 5.11-5.04 (m, 1 H), 4.58-4.46 (m, 2H), 4.11 (d, J = 9.2 Hz, 1H), 4.05-3.94 (m, 1H), 4.00 (s, 3H), 3.65-3.15 (m, under H2O, 3H), 2.69-2.54 (m, 1 H), 2.42-2.30 (m, 1 H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.08-1.99 (m, 1 H), 1.80-1.21 (m, 8H), 1.24 (t, J = 7.0 Hz, 3H), 1.14-1.02 (m, 1H), 1.00-0.87 (m, 1H), 0.94 (s, 9H). M.S.(electrospray) : 760.4 (M-H)" 762.4 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 96 %
Compounds from Table 6
Figure imgf000102_0001
Compound 6016 Compound 6016:
1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): ca, 85:15 mixture of rotamers, major rotamer description; δ 12.28 (s, 2H); 8.56 (s, 1H); 8.04 (s, 1H) 7.79 (s, 1H); 7.46 (s, 1H); 6.96 -7.00 (m, 1H); 5.68-5.75 (m, 1H); 5.40 (s, br, 1H); 5.19 (d, J = 17.0 Hz, 1H); 5.06 (d, J= 10.1 Hz, 1H);4.71 - 4.76 (m,2H); 4.43 (t,J = 8.3, 1H); 4.32-4.34 (m, 1H); 4.13 (d, J = 8.3 Hz, 1H); 3.96-4.03 (m, 1H); 3.77 (s, 3H); 2.67 (s, 3H); 2.40 (d, J = 4.1 Hz, 3H); 2.24-2.36 (m, 3H); 2.03 (q, J = 8.6 Hz, 1H); 1.17 - 1.75 (m, 10H); 1.04 (s, 9H); 0.98 (s, 9H).
M.S.(electrospray) : 845.4 (M-H)" 847.5 (M+H)+ . Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O) : 96.7 %
Synthesis of compounds of formula I wherein Rc is NHSO2Rs:
EXAMPLE 17A
Synthesis of Compound 7001:
Figure imgf000103_0001
17A1 17A2
HATU (20 mg, 0.05 mmol) was added to a solution of compound 17A1 (Compound 3004, Table 3; 20 mg, 0.03 mmol) and DIPEA (0.03 mL, 0.16 mmol) in DMF (1.5 mL) at RT. The solution was stirred for 1h followed by the addition of DMAP (16 mg, 0.13 mmol) and cyclopropanesulfonamide (7.0 mg, 0.06 mmol). After addition was complete, the mixture was allowed to stir for 15 min and DBU (0.02 mL, 0.14 mmol) was added dropwise. The resulting solution was stirred for 16 h at 23°C, then diluted with DMSO to 2.5 mL total volume and purified by prep HPLC (H2O/CH3CN + 0.06% TFA). The fractions containing the pure product were combined and the solvents removed by lyophilization to yield 17A2 as a yellow solid (Compound 7001 , table 7, 5.4 mg, 23 %).
Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O): 98.9% (220 nm). MS: 878.8 (M+H)+, 876.4 (M-H)". 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 10.47 (s, 1 H); 8.82 (s, 1 H); 8.06 (s, br, 1 H); 7.52 (s, br, 1 H); 7.15 (m, 1 H); 7.03 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1H); 5.58 (m, 2H); 5.20 (d, J = 17.0 Hz, 1H); 5.09 (d, J = 11.5, 1H); 4.79 (m, 2H); 4.64 (m, 1 H); 4.36 - 4.52 (m, 2H); 4.06 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1 H); 4.00 - 4.03 (m, 1 H); 2.88 - 2.96 (m, 1H); 2.54 - 2.57 (m, 1 H); 2.10 - 2.20 (m, 2H); 1.32 - 1.71 (m, 11 H); 1.24 (dd, J = 6.3, 1.2 Hz, 6H); 1.00 - 1.08 (m, 8 H); 0.97 (s, 9H).
EXAMPLE 17B
Synthesis of Compound 7002:
Figure imgf000104_0001
17B1 17B2
Using the procedure of Example 17A but starting with compound 17B1 (Compound 6016, Table 6), compound 17B2 (Compound 7002, Table 7) was prepared as a light yellow solid (5.4 mg, 16% yield).
Reverse Phase HPLC Homogeneity (0.06 % TFA; CH3CN : H2O): 93.1 % (220 nm). MS: 950.4 (M+H)+, 948.4 (M-H)". 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 12.26 (s, 1 H); 10.48 (s, 1 H); 8.83 (s, 1 H); 8.02 (s, 1 H); 7.79 (s, 1 H); 7.45 (s, 1 H); 6.94 - 7.00 (m, 1H); 5.56 - 5.65 (m, 1H); 5.40 (s, 1H); 5.19 (d, J = 16.9, 1H); 5.07 (d, J = 11.4, 1H); 4.77 (s, 1H); 4.33 - 4.42 (m, 2H); 4.11 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1 H); 3.97 (d, J = 9.6, 1 H); 3.76 (s, 3H); 3.76 (s, 3H); 2.88 - 2.96 (m, 1H); 2.66 (s, 3H); 2.53 - 2.60 (m, 1 H); 2.31 - 2.33 (m, 1 H); 2.11 - 2.19 (m, 2H); 1.33 - 1.70 (m, 12H); 1.22 (s, br, 1 H); 1.05 - 1.08 (m, 2H); 1.02 (s, 9H); 0.98 (s, 9H).
EXAMPLE 17C
Synthesis of Compound 7003:
Figure imgf000104_0002
17C1 17C3
Compound 17C1 (Compound 1027, Table 1 ; 35 mg, 0.045 mmol), N,N- dimethylsulfamide 17C2 (22.3 mg, 0.180 mmol) DIPEA (39.3 μl, 0.225 mmol) and DMAP (22 mg, 0.180 mmol) were dissolved in DMF (2.5 mL) and to the mixture was added DBU ( 28.5 μl, 0.203 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred for 5 min, then HATU (18.8 mg, 0.05 mmol) was added. Stirring was continued for 12h and the residue was filtered through Millex filter and purified by Prep HPLC (Combiscreen ODS-AQ, 20 x 50mm). The pure fractions were pooled together and lyophilized to afford 14 mg (yield, 35%) of compound 17C3 (Compound 7003, Table 7) as a yellow solid.
1HNMR (400MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 10.23 (s, 1 H), 8.74 (s, 1 H), 8.07 ( d, J=8Hz, 1 H), 7.59 (s, 1 H), 7.45-7.30 (m, 1 H), 7.27 (d, J=8Hz, 1 H), 5.53-5.49 (m, 2H), 5.20 (d, J= 17Hz, 1 H), 5.10 (d, J=12Hz, 1 H), 4.70 (bs, 1 H), 4.50-4.30 (m, 3H), 4.15-4.05 (m, 2H), 3.97 (s, 3H), 2.76 (s, 6H), 2.55 (s,3H), 2.38-2.32 (m,1H), 2.23-2.08 (m, 2H), 1.97-1.81 (m, 1 H), 1.75-1.45 (m,4H), 1.32-1.14 (m,9H), 1.04-0.86 (m, 11 H). EIMS: (M+H) = 885.4, (M-H) = 883.4
EXAMPLE 18
NS3-NS4A protease assay
The enzymatic assay used to evaluate the present compound is described in WO 00/09543 and WO 00/59929.
EXAMPLE 19
Cell Based HCV RNA Replication Assay
Cell Culture
Huh7 cells that stably maintain a subgenomic HCV replicon were established as previously described (Lohman et al., 1999. Science 285: 110-113) and designated as the S22.3 cell-line. S22.3 cells are maintained in Dulbecco's Modified Earle Medium (DMEM) supplemented with 10% FBS and 1 mg/mL neomycin (Standard Medium). During the assay, DMEM medium supplemented with 10% FBS, containing 0.5% DMSO and lacking neomycin was used (Assay Medium). 16 hours prior to compound addition, S22.3 cells are trypsinized and diluted to 50 000 cells/mL in Standard Medium. 200 μL (10 000 cells) are distributed into each well of a 96-well plate. The plate was then incubated at 37°C with 5% CO2 until the next day.
Figure imgf000105_0001
Figure imgf000106_0001
Preparation of Test Compound
10 μL of test compound (in 100% DMSO) was added to 2 mL of Assay Medium for a final DMSO concentration of 0.5% and the solution was sonicated for 15 min and filtered through a 0.22 μM Millipore Filter Unit. 900 μL was transferred into row A of a Polypropylene Deep-Well Titer Plate. Rows B to H contain 400 μL aliquots of Assay Medium (containing 0.5% DMSO), and are used to prepare serial dilutions (1/2) by transferring 400 μL from row to row (no compound was included in row H).
Application. of test compound to cells
Cell culture medium was aspirated from the 96-well plate containing the S22.3 cells. 175 μL of assay medium with the appropriate dilution of test compound was transferred from each well of the compound plate to the corresponding well of the cell culture plate (row H was used as the "No inhibition control"). The cell culture plate was incubated at 37°C with 5% CO2for 72 h.
Extraction of Total Cellular RNA
Following the 72 h incubation period, the total cellular RNA was extracted from the
S22.3 cells of the 96-well plate using the RNeasy 96 kit (Qiagen®, RNeasy Handbook. 1999.). Briefly, assay medium was completely removed from cells and 100 μL of RLT buffer (Qiagen®) containing 143 mM β-mercaptoethanol was added to each well of the 96-well cell-culture plate. The microplate was gently shaken for 20 sec. 100 μL of 70% ethanol was then added to each microplate well, and mixed by pipetting. The lysate was removed and applied to the wells of a RNeasy 96 (Qiagen®) plate that was placed on top of a Qiagen® Square-Well Block. The
RNeasy 96 plate was sealed with tape and the Square-Well Block with the RNeasy 96 plate was loaded into the holder and placed in a rotor bucket of a 4K15C centrifuge. The sample was centrifuged at 6000 rpm (-5600 x g) for 4 min at room temperature. The tape was removed from the plate and 0.8 mL of Buffer RW1 (Qiagen® RNeasy 96 kit) was added to each well of the RNeasy 96 plate. The RNeasy 96 plate was sealed with a new piece of tape and centrifuged at 6000 rpm for 4 min at room temperature. The RNeasy 96 plate was placed on top of another clean Square-Well Block, the tape removed and 0.8 mL of Buffer RPE (Qiagen® RNeasy 96 kit) was added to each well of the RNeasy 96 plate. The RNeasy 96 plate was sealed with a new piece of tape and centrifuged at 6000 rpm for 4 min at room temperature. The tape was removed and another 0.8 mL of Buffer RPE (Qiagen® RNeasy 96 kit) was added to each well of the RNeasy 96 plate. The RNeasy 96 plate was sealed with a new piece of tape and centrifuged at 6000 rpm for 10 min at room temperature. Tape was removed, the RNeasy 96 plate was placed on top of a rack containing 1.2-mL collection microtubes. The RNA was eluted by adding 50 μL of RNase-free water to each well, sealing plate with a new piece of tape and incubated for 1 min at room temperature. The plate was then centrifuged at 6000 rpm for 4 min at room temperature. The elution step was repeated with a second volume of 50 μL RNase-free water. The microtubes with total cellular RNA are stored at -70°.
Quantification of Total Cellular RNA
RNA was quantified on the STORM® system (Molecular Dynamics®) using the RiboGreen® RNA Quantification Kit (Molecular Probes®). Briefly, the RiboGreen reagent was diluted 200-fold in TE (10 mM Tris-HCI pH =7.5, 1 mM EDTA). Generally, 50 μL of reagent was diluted in 10 mL TE. A Standard Curve of ribosomal RNA was diluted in TE to 2 μg/mL and pre-determined amounts (100, 50, 40, 20, 10, 5, 2 and 0 μL) of the ribosomal RNA solution are then transferred in a new 96- well plate (COSTAR # 3997) and the volume was completed to 100 μL with TE. Generally, column 1 of the 96-well plate was used for the standard curve and the other wells are used for the RNA samples to be quantified. 10 μL of each RNA sample that was to be quantified, was transferred to the corresponding well of the 96-well plate and 90 μL of TE was added. One volume (100 μL) of diluted RiboGreen reagent was added to each well of the 96-well plate and incubated for 2 to 5 minutes at room temperature, protected from light (a 10 μL RNA sample in a 200 μL final volume generates a 20X dilution). The fluorescence intensity of each well was measured on the STORM® system (Molecular Dynamics®). A standard curve was created on the basis of the known quantities of the ribosomal RNA and the resulting fluorescent intensities. The RNA concentration in the experimental samples was determined from the standard curve and corrected for the 20X dilution.
Reagents and Materials:
Figure imgf000108_0001
Real-Time R.T.-PCR The Real-Time R.T.-PCR was performed on the ABI Prism 7700 Sequence
Detection System using the TaqMan EZ R.T.-PCR Kit from (Perkin-Elmer Applied Biosystems®). R.T.-PCR was optimized for the quantification of the 5' IRES of HCV RNA by using the Taqman technology (Roche Molecular Diagnostics Systems) similar to the technique previously described (Martell et al., 1999. J. Clin. Microbiol. 37: 327-332). The system exploits the 5'-3' nucleolytic activity of AmpliTaq DNA polymerase. Briefly, the method utilizes a dual-labeled fluorogenic hybridization probe (PUTR Probe) that specifically anneals to the template between the PCR primers (primers 8125 and 7028). The 5' end of the probe contains a fluorescent reporter (6-carboxyfluorescein [FAM]) and the 3' end contains a fluorescent quencher (6-carboxytetramethylrhodamine [TAMRA]). The FAM reporter's emission spectrum was suppressed by the quencher on the intact hybridization probe. Nuclease degradation of the hybridization probe releases the reporter, resulting in an increase in fluorescence emission. The ABI Prism 7700 sequence detector measures the increase in fluorescence emission continuously during the PCR amplification such that the amplified product was directly proportion to the signal. The amplification plot was analysed early in the reaction at a point that represents the logarithmic phase of product accumulation. A point representing a defined detection threshold of the increase inthe fluorescent signal associated with the exponential growth of the PCR product for the sequence detector was defined as the cycle threshold (Cτ). Cr values are inversely proportional to the quantity of input HCV RNA; such that under identical PCR conditions, the larger the starting concentration of HCV RNA, the lower the Cτ. A standard curve was created automatically by the ABI Prism 7700 detection system by plotting the Cτ against each standard dilution of known HCV RNA concentration.
Reference samples for the standard curve are included on each R.T.-PCR plate. HCV Replicon RNA was synthesized (by T7 transcription) in vitro, purified and quantified by OD260. Considering that 1 μg of this RNA = 2.15 X 1011 RNA copies, dilutions are made in order to have 108, 107, 106, 105, 104, 103 or 102 genomic RNA copies / 5 μL. Total cellular Huh-7 RNA was also incorporated with each dilution (50 ng / 5 μL). 5 μL of each reference standard (HCV Replicon + Huh-7 RNA) was combined with 45 μL of Reagent Mix, and used in the Real-Time R.T.-PCR reaction.
The Real-Time R.T.-PCR reaction was set-up for the experimental samples that were purified on RNeasy 96 -well plates by combining 5 μL of each total cellular RNA sample with 45 μL of Reagent Mix.
Reagents and Materials:
Figure imgf000109_0001
Reagent Mix preparation:
Figure imgf000109_0002
Figure imgf000110_0001
Forward Primer Sequence (SEQ ID. 1): 5' - ACG CAG AAA GCG TCT AGC CAT
GGC GTT AGT - 3'
Reverse Primer Sequence (SEQ ID NO. 2): 5' - TCC CGG GGC ACT CGC AAG
CAC CCT ATC AGG - 3'
Note: Those primers amplify a region of 256-nt present within the 5' untranslated region of HCV.
PUTR Probe Sequence (SEQ ID NO. 3): 1 6FAM | - TGG TCT GCG GAA CCG
GTG AGT ACA CC - TAMRA
No Template Controls (NTC): On each plate, 4 wells are used as "NTC". For these controls, 5 μL of water are added to the well in place of RNA.
Thermal Cycling Conditions: 50°C 2 min 60°C 30 min 95°C 5 min 95 °C 15 sec for 2 cycles 60°C 1 min
90°C 15 sec for 40 cycles 60°C 1 min
Following the termination of the R.T.-PCR reaction the data analysis requires setting of threshold fluorescence signal for the PCR plate and a standard curve was constructed by plotting the Cτ value versus RNA copy number used in each reference reaction. The Cτ values obtained for the assay samples are used to interpolate an RNA copy number based on the standard curve. Finally, the RNA copy number was normalized (based on the RiboGreen RNA quantification of the total RNA extracted from the cell culture well) and expressed as genome equivalents / μg of total RNA [g.e./μg].
The RNA copy number [g.e./μg] from each well of the cell culture plate was a measure of the amount of replicating HCV RNA in the presence of various concentrations of inhibitor. The % inhibition was calculated with the following equation:
100 - [(g.e μg inh)/(g.e./μg ctl)x 100].
A non-linear curve fit with the Hill model was applied to the inhibition-concentration data, and the 50% effective concentration (EC50) was calculated by the use of SAS software (Statistical Software System; SAS Institute, Inc. Cary, N.C.).
When the compounds of this invention are evaluated in the preceding enzymatic and cell based assays, the compounds are found to be highly active.
EXAMPLE 20
Specificity assays
The specificity assays used to evaluate the selectivity of this compound are described in WO 00/09543.
When the compounds were evaluated in the specificity assays, the compounds of formula 1 were found to be selective in that they do not show significant inhibition (no measurable activity at concentrations up to 30 μM) in the Human Leukocyte Elastase and Cathepsin B assays.
EXAMPLE 21 ,
Pharmacokinetic properties
The present invention comprises compounds that show pharmacokinetic properties such as detectable plasma levels in the rat at 1 hour and 2 h after an oral dose of 5 mg/kg.
More explicitly, the following assay, an in vivo oral absorption screen, is used to determine plasma levels of test compounds in a rat after oral administration:
Materials and Methods: 1. Method used to pool compounds ("cassette selection"):
The selection of compounds to be pooled into a "cassette" was based on their structural similarity and physicochemical properties. A solid phase extraction method applicable to all the selected compounds was established. Based on the initial testing where each compound was spiked into rat plasma and run through HPLC or HPLC/MS at a concentration of 0.5 μM, the retention time, ionic mass, and the possible separation among compounds by HPLC and/or HPLC/MS were used as basis for pooling 3-4 compounds into one "cassette".
2. Oral vehicle and compound preparation: Each "cassette" contains 3-4 compounds at 5 or 4 mg/kg for each compound. The cassettes were prepared as an oral suspension in 0.5% aqueous methylcellulose and 0.3%) of polyoxyethylene (20) sorbitan monooleate (Tween-80). The dosing volume was 10 mL/kg via oral gavage.
3. Dosing and plasma sampling:
Male Sprague Dawley rats were fasted overnight in individual cages, with access to aqueous 10% dextrose. Two rats were dosed with each "cassette". Plasma samples (~1 mL) were collected at 1 and 2 h post-dosing from the 2 rats and pooled for extraction and analysis. 4. Compound extraction and analysis:
From each cassette, plasma samples at 1 and 2 h, blank plasma, blank plasma spiked with all the compounds at 0.5 μM of each, are extracted by the solid phase extraction method. Samples were analyzed by HPLC and HPLC/MS for comparison purpose. Plasma concentrations are estimated based on the single concentration of 0.5 μM standard.
Results When assayed in the preceding screen, some compounds of this invention are found in the plasma at the 1 hour and 2 hour intervals following oral administration, with blood plasma levels up to 1.5 /M.
TABLES OF COMPOUNDS
In the following examples of compounds according to this invention are listed in the Tables 1 to 7, wherein Me defines methyl, Et defines ethyl and tBu defines tert- butyl. Compounds according to this invention usually show IC50 values lower than about 200 nM and EC50 values lower than about 300 nM.
TABLE 1
Figure imgf000114_0001
Figure imgf000115_0001
Figure imgf000116_0001
Figure imgf000117_0001
Figure imgf000118_0001
Figure imgf000119_0001
Figure imgf000120_0001
Figure imgf000121_0001
Figure imgf000122_0001
Figure imgf000123_0001
Figure imgf000124_0001
Figure imgf000125_0001
Figure imgf000126_0001
Figure imgf000127_0001
Figure imgf000128_0001
Figure imgf000129_0001
Figure imgf000130_0001
Figure imgf000131_0001
TABLE 2
Figure imgf000132_0001
Figure imgf000132_0002
Figure imgf000133_0001
Figure imgf000134_0001
TABLE 3
Figure imgf000135_0001
Figure imgf000135_0002
Figure imgf000136_0001
TABLE 4
Figure imgf000137_0001
Figure imgf000137_0002
Figure imgf000138_0001
TABLE 5
Figure imgf000139_0001
Figure imgf000139_0002
TABLE 6
Figure imgf000140_0001
Figure imgf000140_0002
Figure imgf000141_0001
Figure imgf000142_0003
TABLE 7
Figure imgf000142_0001
Figure imgf000142_0002

Claims

CLAIMSWhat is claimed is:
1. A racemate, diastereoisomer, or optical isomer of a compound of formula (I):
Figure imgf000143_0001
wherein
B is (C1-ιo)alkyl, (C3.7)cycloalkyl, or (C1-4)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, a) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri- substituted with (C1-3)alkyl; and b) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di- substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and ©-(CAalkyl; and c) wherein each of said alkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with halogen; and d) wherein each of said cycloalkyl groups being 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered having optionally one (for the 4-, 5, 6, or 7-membered) or two (for the 5-, 6- or 7-membered) -CH2-groups not directly linked to each other replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C- atoms; X is O or NH;
R3 is (C2.8)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl or (Cι-3)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri- substituted with (C1-4)alkyl; L° is H, halogen, (C1-4)alkyl, -OH, -O- C-Aalkyl, -NH2, -NH(C1-4)alkyl or
-N((C1-4)alkyl)2; L\ L2 are each independently halogen, cyano, (C-Aalkyl, -O-(C-|.4)alkyl, -S-(C1- )alkyl, -SO-(C1-4)alkyl, or -SO2-(Cι-4)alkyl, wherein each of said alkyl groups is optionally substituted with from one to three halogen atoms; and either L1 or L2 (but not both at the same time) may also be H; or L° and L1 or
L° and L2 may be covalently bonded to form, together with the two C-atoms to which they are linked, a 5- or 6-membered carbocyclic ring wherein one or two -CH2-groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced each independently by -O- or NRa wherein Ra is H or (C1-4)alkyl, and wherein said carbo- or heterocyclic ring is optionally mono- or di-substituted with (C1-4)alkyl; R2 is R20, -NR22COR20, -NR22COOR20 -NR22R21 or -NR22CONR21R23, wherein R20 is selected from (C1-8)alkyl, (C3.7)cycloalkyl and (C1-4)alkyl- (C3-7)cycloalkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C1-3)alkyl; R21 is H or R20 as defined above,
R22 and R23 are independently selected from H and methyl, R1 is ethyl or vinyl; Rc is hydroxy or NHSO2Rs wherein Rs is (C1-6)alkyl, (C3.7)cycloalkyl, (C1-6)alkyl- (C3.7)cycloalkyl, phenyl, naphthyl, pyridinyl, (ClJt)alkyl-phenyl, (C1-4)alkyl- naphthyl or (CAalkyl-pyridinyl; each of which optionally being mono-, di- or tri-substituted with substituents selected from halogen, hydroxy, cyano, (C1-4)alkyl, O- CAalkyl, -CO-NH2, -CO-NH(C1-4)alkyl, -CO-N((C1-4)alkyl)2, -NH2, -NH(C1-4)alkyl and -N((C1-4)alkyl)2, wherein (C1-4)alkyl and O-(C1-6)alkyl are optionally substituted with one to three halogen atoms; and each of which optionally being monosubstituted with nitro; or Rs is -N(RN2)RN1), wherein RN1 and RN2 are independently selected from H, (C1-6)alkyl, (C3.7)cycloalkyl, (C1-6)alkyl-(C3.7)cycloalkyl, aryl and (C1-6)alkyl- aryl; wherein said (C1-6)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl, (Cι-6)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, aryl and (Cι.6)alkyl-aryl are optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from halogen, (CAalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, O-(C1-6)alkyl, -NH2, -NH(C1-4)alkyl, -N((C1-4)alkyi)2, -CO-NH2, -CO-NH CAalkyl, -CO-N((C1-4)alkyl)2, -COOH, and -COO(C1-6)alkyl; or RN2 and RN1 are linked, together with the nitrogen to which they are bonded, to form a 3- to 7-membered monocyclic saturated or unsaturated heterocycle or a 9- or 10-membered bicyclic saturated or unsaturated heterocycle, each of which optionally containing from one to three further heteroatoms independently selected from N, S and O, and each of which being optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from halogen, (C -6)alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, O-(C1-6)alkyl, -NH2, -NH(C1-4)alkyl, -N((C1-4)alkyl)2, -CO-NH2, -CO-NH(C )alkyl, -CO-N((C1-4)alkyl)2, -COOH, and -COO(C1-6)alkyl; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof.
2. The compound according to claim 1 wherein
B is
Figure imgf000145_0001
(C3.7)cycloalkyl, or (C1-4)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, a) wherein said cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C1-3)alkyl; and b) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di-substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and O-(C^)alkyl; and c) wherein all said alkyl-groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with halogen; and d) wherein all said cycloalkyl-groups being 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered having optionally one (for the 4-, 5, 6, or 7-membered) or two (for the 5-, 6- or 7-membered) -CH2-groups not directly linked to each other replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C-atoms;
X is O or NH;
R3 is (C2.8)alkyl, (C3.7)cycloalkyl or (C1-3)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C1-4)alkyl; L° is H, -OH, -O-(C1-4)alkyl, -NH2, -NH(C1-4)alkyl or -N((C1-4)alkyl)2;
L1, L2 are each independently halogen, (C1-4)alkyl, -O-(C1-4)alkyl or -S-(C1-4)alkyl (in any oxidized state such as SO or SO2); and either L1 or L2 (but not both at the same time) may also be H; or
L° and L1 or L° and L2 may be covalently bonded to form, together with the two C-atoms to which they are linked, a 5- or 6-membered carbocyclic ring wherein one or two -CH2-groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced each independently by -O- or NRa wherein Ra is H or (CAalkyl, and wherein said carbo- or heterocyclic ring is optionally mono- or di-substituted with (C1-4)alkyl; R2 is R20, -NR22COR20, -NR22COOR20 -NR22R21 and -NR22CONR21R23, wherein
R20 is selected from (C1-8)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl and (C-Aalkyl- (C3.7)cycloalkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C1-3)alkyl;
R2 is H or has one of the meanings of R20 as defined above,
R22 and R23 are independently selected from H and methyl, R1 is ethyl or vinyl; Rc is hydroxy or NHSO2Rs wherein Rs is (C1-6)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl,
(C1.6)alkyl-(C3.7)cycloalkyl, phenyl, naphthyl, pyridinyl, (CAalkyl- phenyl, (C1-4)alkyl-naphthyl or (C1-4)alkyl-pyridinyl; all of which optionally being mono-, di- or tri-substituted with substituents selected from halogen, hydroxy, cyano, (C1-4)alkyl, O-(C1-6)alkyl, -CO-NH2, -CO-NH(C^)alkyl, -CO-N((C1-4)alkyl)2) -NH2> -NH(C1-4)alkyl and -N((C1-4)alkyl)2; and all of which optionally being monosubstituted with nitro; or Rs can be further selected from: -NH(C1-6)alkyl, N((C1-6)alkyl)2,
-Het,
Figure imgf000146_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof.
3. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein B is selected from (C2-8)alkyl, (C3- )cycloalkyl and (Cι.3)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, a) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C1-3)alkyl; and b) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di- substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and O-(C - )alkyl; and c) wherein each of said alkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with fluorine or mono-substituted with chlorine or bromine; and d) wherein in each of said cycloalkyl groups being 5-, 6- or 7-membered, one or two -CH2-groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C-atoms.
The compound according to claim 3 wherein B is selected from ethyl, n- propyl, te/f-butyl, 2-methylpropyl, 1 ,2-dimethylpropyl, 1 ,2,2-trimethylpropyl, 2- fluoroethyl, 3-fluoropropyl, 3,3,3-trifluoropropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl and 1 -methylcyclohexyl, and a group selected from: ,
Figure imgf000147_0001
5. The compound according to claim 4 wherein B is selected from ethyl, n- propyl, terf-butyl, cyclopentyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl, 2-fluoroethyl or 3- fluoropropyl.
6. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein X is O.
7. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein X is NH.
8. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein R3 is (C2-6)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl or (C1-3)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, each of which being optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from (C1-4)alkyl.
9. The compound according to claim 8 wherein R3 is selected from 1,1- dimethylethyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl and 1 -methylcyclohexyl.
10. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein L° is selected from H, halogen, CH3, -OH, -OCH3, -OC2H5, -OC3H7, -OCH(CH3)2, -NHCHs, -NHC2H5, -NHC3H7, -NHCH(CH3)2, -N(CH3)2, -N(CH3)C2H5, -N(CH3)C3H7 and -N(CH3)CH(CH3)2-
11. The compound according to claim 10 wherein L° is selected from H, -OH, - OCH3, halogen and -N(CH3)2.
12. The compound according to claim 11 wherein L° is selected from H, -OH or
Figure imgf000148_0001
13. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein L1 and L2are each independently selected from: halogen, -CH3, -C2H5, -OCH3, -OC2H5, -OC3H7, -OCH(CH3)2, CF3, -SMe, -SOMe, and SO2Me whereby either L1 or L2 may be H.
14. The compound according to claim 13 wherein either one of L1 and L2 is - CH3) -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO2Me and the other of L1 and L2 is H.
15. The compound according to claim 14 wherein L1 is CH3, -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, - SMe, or -SO2Me and L2 is H.
16. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein L° is selected from H, -OH and -OCH3; and either one of L1 and L2is CH3, -F, - Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO2Me and the other of L1 and L2 is H.
17. The compound according to claim 16 wherein L° is selected from H, -OH and -OCH3; L1 is CH3, -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO2Me and L2 is H.
18. The compound according to claim 17 wherein L° is selected from H and -OCH3; L1 is CH3, -Cl or -Br and L2 is H.
19. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein L° and L1 are covalently bonded to form, together with the quinoline residue to which they are linked, a ring system which is selected from:
Figure imgf000149_0001
wherein each Rb is independently (C1- )alkyl and L2 is defined as in claim 1.
20. The compound according to claim 19 wherein L2 is H or methyl.
21. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein R2 is R20, -NHCOR20, -NHCOOR20, -NHR21 or -NHCONR21R23, wherein R20 is selected from (C1.8)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl, and (C1-3)alkyl- (C3-7)cycloalkyl, wherein each of said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C1-3)alkyl; and R21 is H or R20 as defined above; and R23 is H or methyl.
22. The compound according to claim 21 wherein R2 is -NHCOR20, -NHCOOR20, or -NHR21.
23. The compound according to claim 22 wherein R20 and R21 are independently selected from: methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, /-propyl, n-butyl, 1-methylpropyl, 2- methylpropyl, te f-butyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, 1 ,1-dimethylpropyl, 1 ,2- dimethylpropyl, 1 ,2,2-trimethylpropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, each of said cycloalkyl or alkyl-cycloalkyl groups optionally being mono- or di-substituted with methyl or ethyl.
24. The compound according to claim 23 wherein R20 and R21 are independently selected from methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, /-propyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, cyclopentyl and cyclopentylmethyl.
25. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein R is vinyl.
26. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein Rc is hydroxy, NHSO2-methyl, NHSO2-ethyl, NHSO2-(1-methyl)ethyl, NHSO2- propyl, NHSO2-cyclopropyl, NHSO2-CH2-cyclopropyl, NHSO2-cyclobutyl,
NHSO2-cyclopentyl or NHSO2-phenyl.
27. The compound according to claim 26 wherein Rc is hydroxy.
28. The compound according to claim 26 wherein Rc is NHSO2-cyclopropyl.
29. The compound according to one or more of the preceding claims wherein Rc is NHSO2N(RN2)RN1), wherein RN1 and RN2 are independently selected from H, (C-Aalkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl, (C1-3)alkyl-(C3- )cycloalkyl, phenyl, and (C1-3)alkyl-phenyl; wherein said (CAalkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl,
(C1-3)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, phenyl and (C1-3)alkyl-phenyl are optionally substituted with one, two or three substituents independently selected from halogen, (CAalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, O-(C1-6)alkyl, -NH2, -NH(C1-4)alkyl, -N((C1-4)alkyl)2, -CO-NH2, -CO-NH(C1-4)alkyl, -CO-N((C1-4)alkyl)2, -COOH, and -COO(C1-6)alkyl; or
RN2 and RN1 are linked, together with the nitrogen to which they are bonded, to form a 5 or 6-membered monocyclic heterocycle which may be saturated or unsaturated, optionally containing from one to three further heteroatoms independently selected from N, S and O, and optionally substituted with one, two or three substituents independently selected from halogen, (C1-6)alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, O-(C1-6)alkyl, -NH2, -NH(CM)alkyl, -N((C -4)alkyl)2, -CO-NH2, -CO-NH(C1-4)alkyl, -CO-N((C1-4)alkyl)2, -COOH, and -COO(C1-6)alkyl.
30. The compound according to claim 1 wherein
B is (C2.8)alkyl, (C3-7)cycloalkyl or (C1.3)alkyl-(C3-7)cycloalkyl, a) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C1-3)alkyl; and b) wherein said alkyl, cycloalkyl, and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono- or di-substituted with substituents selected from hydroxy and O- (C1-4)alkyl; and c) wherein each of said alkyl groups may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with fluorine or mono-substituted with chlorine or bromine; and d) wherein in each of said cycloalkyl groups being 5-, 6- or 7- membered, one or two -CH2-groups not being directly linked to each other may be replaced by -O- such that the O-atom is linked to the group X via at least two C-atoms; X is O or NH; R3 is (C2.6)alkyl or (C3.7)cycloalkyl, both of which being optionally substituted with 1 to 3 substituents selected from (C1- )alkyl; L° is H, -OH, -OCH3, halogen or -N(CH3)2;
L1 and L2 are each independently selected from: halogen, -CH3, -C2H5, - OCH3, -OC2H5, -OC3H7, -OCH(CH3)2, CF3, -SMe, -SOMe, and SO2Me, whereby either L1 or L2 may be H;
R2 is R20, -NHCOR20, -NHCOOR20, -NHR21 and -NHCONR21R23, wherein
R20 is selected from (C1-8)alkyl, (C3.7)cycloalkyl, (C1-3)alkyl- (C3-7)cycloalkyl, wherein said cycloalkyl and alkyl-cycloalkyl may be mono-, di- or tri-substituted with (C1-3)alkyl; and
R21 is H or R20 as defined above; and R23 is H or methyl; R1 is ethyl or vinyl; and
Rc is hydroxy, NHSO2-methyl, NHSO2-ethyl, NHSO2-(1-methyl)ethyl, NHSO2-propyl, NHSO2-cyclopropyl, NHSO2-CH2-cyclopropyl, NHSO2- cyclobutyl, NHSO2-cyclopentyl or NHSO2-phenyl.
31. The compound according to claim 30 wherein
B is selected from: ethyl, n-propyl, tef-butyl, 2-methylpropyl, 1,2- dimethylpropyl, 1 ,2,2-trimethylpropyl, 2-fluoroethyl, 3-fluoropropyl, 3,3,3- trifluoropropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl and 1 -methylcyclohexyl, and a group selected from:
Figure imgf000152_0001
R3 is selected from 1 ,1-dimethylethyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl and 1- methylcyclohexyl; L° is H, -OH or-OCH3; L1 is CH3, -F, -Cl, -Br, -OMe, -SMe, or -SO2Me; L2 is H;
R2 is -NHCOR20, -NHCOOR20 or -NHR21, wherein R20 and R2 are independently selected from methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, /-propyl, 2,2- dimethylpropyl, cyclopentyl and cyclopentylmethyl;
R1 is vinyl; and Rc is hydroxy or NHSO2-cyclopropyl.
32. The compound according to claim 31 wherein B is selected from ethyl, n- propyl, te f-butyl, cyclopentyl, 1-methylcyclopentyl, 2-fluoroethyl and 3- fluoropropyl; R3 is selected from 1 ,1-dimethylethyl and cyclohexyl; L° is H or -OCH3; L1 is -CH3, -Cl, or -Br; L2 is H; and Rc is hydroxy.
33. The compound according to claim 1 of the formula
Figure imgf000152_0002
Figure imgf000153_0001
Figure imgf000154_0001
Figure imgf000155_0001
Figure imgf000156_0001
Figure imgf000157_0001
Figure imgf000158_0001
Figure imgf000159_0001
Figure imgf000160_0001
Figure imgf000161_0001
Figure imgf000162_0001
Figure imgf000163_0001
Figure imgf000164_0001
Figure imgf000165_0001
Figure imgf000166_0001
Figure imgf000167_0001
Figure imgf000168_0001
Figure imgf000169_0001
Figure imgf000170_0003
34. The compound according to claim 1 of the formula
Figure imgf000170_0001
Figure imgf000170_0002
Figure imgf000171_0001
Figure imgf000172_0002
35. The compound according to claim 1 of the formula
Figure imgf000172_0001
Figure imgf000173_0001
Figure imgf000174_0003
36. The compound according to claim 1 of the formula
Figure imgf000174_0001
Figure imgf000174_0002
Figure imgf000175_0001
Figure imgf000176_0002
37. The compound according to claim 1 of the formula
Figure imgf000176_0001
Figure imgf000177_0001
38. The compound according to claim 1 of the formula
Figure imgf000177_0002
Figure imgf000177_0003
Figure imgf000178_0001
Figure imgf000179_0001
39. The compound according to claim 1 of the formula
Figure imgf000180_0001
wh
Figure imgf000180_0002
40. A pharmaceutical composition comprising an anti-hepatitis C virally effective amount of a compound of formula I according to one or more of claims 1 to 39 or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, in admixture with a. pharmaceutically acceptable carrier medium or auxiliary agent.
41. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 40 further comprising a therapeuticaily effective amount of at least one other antiviral agent.
42. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 41 , wherein said antiviral agent is ribavirin.
43. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 41 , wherein said antiviral agent is selected from another anti-HCV agent, HIV inhibitor, HAV inhibitor and HBV inhibitor.
44. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 43, wherein said other anti-HCV agent is selected from immunomodulatory agents, other inhibitors of HCV NS3 protease, inhibitors of HCV polymerase and inhibitors of another target in the HCV life cycle.
45. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 44, wherein said , immunomodulatory agent is selected from α-interferon and pegylated α- interferon.
46. The pharmaceutical composition according to claim 44, wherein said inhibitor of another target in the HCV life cycle is selected from inhibitors of: helicase, NS2/3 protease and internal ribosome entry site (IRES).
47. A method for the treatment or prevention of a hepatitis C viral infection in a mammal by administering to the mammal an anti-hepatitis C virally effective amount of a compound of formula I according to one or more of claims 1 to 39, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof.
48. A method for the treatment or prevention of a hepatitis C viral infection in a mammal by administering thereto an anti-hepatitis C virally effective amount of a compound of formula I according to one or more of claims 1 to 39, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof in combination with at least one other antiviral agent.
49. The method according to claim 48, wherein said antiviral agent is ribavirin.
50. The method according to claim 48, wherein said other antiviral agent is selected from another anti-HCV agent, HIV inhibitor, HAV inhibitor and HBV inhibitor.
51. The method according to claim 50, wherein said other anti-HCV agent is selected from immunomodulatory agents, other inhibitors of HCV NS3 protease, inhibitors of HCV polymerase and inhibitors of another target in the HCV life cycle.
52. The method according to claim 51 , wherein said immunomodulatory agent is selected from α-interferon and pegylated α-interferon.
53. The method according to claim 51 , wherein said inhibitor of another target in the HCV life cycle is selected from inhibitors of: helicase, NS2/3 protease and internal ribosome entry site (IRES).
54. Use of a compound of formula I, including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof, according to one or more of claims 1 to 39 for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of hepatitis C viral infection in a mammal.
55. A method of inhibiting the replication of hepatitis C virus by exposing the virus to a hepatitis C viral NS3 protease inhibiting amount of the compound of formula (I) according to one or more of claims 1 to 39, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof.
56. An article of manufacture comprising packaging material contained within which is a composition effective to treat an HCV infection or to inhibit the NS3 protease of HCV and the packaging material comprises a label which indicates that the composition can be used to treat infection by the hepatitis C virus, and wherein said composition comprises a compound of formula (I) according to one or more of claims 1 to 39 or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or ester thereof.
PCT/CA2004/000750 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds WO2004103996A1 (en)

Priority Applications (18)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
YUP-2005/0871A RS51294B (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds
MXPA05012545A MXPA05012545A (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds.
KR1020057022088A KR101115294B1 (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis C inhibitor compounds
PL04733750T PL1654261T3 (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds
SI200430588T SI1654261T1 (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds
JP2006529495A JP4447603B2 (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis C inhibitor compound
EP04733750A EP1654261B1 (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds
MEP-583/08A MEP58308A (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds
CA2522577A CA2522577C (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds
AU2004240704A AU2004240704B9 (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis C inhibitor compounds
DK04733750T DK1654261T3 (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis C inhibitor compounds
NZ544076A NZ544076A (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis C inhibitor compounds
DE602004010137T DE602004010137T2 (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 COMPOUNDS AS HEPATITIS C INHIBITORS
EA200501689A EA009295B1 (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds
BRPI0410456A BRPI0410456B8 (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 hepatitis c inhibitor compounds, pharmaceutical composition, use thereof, as well as an article of manufacture
IL172013A IL172013A (en) 2003-05-21 2005-11-17 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds and pharmaceutical compositions comprising them
NO20056047A NO332056B1 (en) 2003-05-21 2005-12-19 Hepatitis C inhibitor compounds, pharmaceutical compositions containing them as well as such compounds for the treatment of disease
HR20080014T HRP20080014T3 (en) 2003-05-21 2008-01-11 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US47270903P 2003-05-21 2003-05-21
US60/472,709 2003-05-21

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2004103996A1 true WO2004103996A1 (en) 2004-12-02

Family

ID=33476973

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/CA2004/000750 WO2004103996A1 (en) 2003-05-21 2004-05-19 Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds

Country Status (33)

Country Link
US (5) US7585845B2 (en)
EP (1) EP1654261B1 (en)
JP (2) JP4447603B2 (en)
KR (1) KR101115294B1 (en)
CN (3) CN103204903A (en)
AT (1) ATE378334T1 (en)
AU (1) AU2004240704B9 (en)
BR (1) BRPI0410456B8 (en)
CA (1) CA2522577C (en)
CL (1) CL2004001161A1 (en)
CO (1) CO5630024A2 (en)
CY (1) CY1107200T1 (en)
DE (1) DE602004010137T2 (en)
DK (1) DK1654261T3 (en)
EA (1) EA009295B1 (en)
EC (1) ECSP056181A (en)
ES (1) ES2297424T3 (en)
HR (1) HRP20080014T3 (en)
IL (1) IL172013A (en)
ME (1) MEP58308A (en)
MX (1) MXPA05012545A (en)
MY (1) MY143076A (en)
NO (1) NO332056B1 (en)
NZ (1) NZ544076A (en)
PE (1) PE20050204A1 (en)
PL (1) PL1654261T3 (en)
PT (1) PT1654261E (en)
RS (1) RS51294B (en)
TW (1) TWI327145B (en)
UA (1) UA83046C2 (en)
UY (1) UY28323A1 (en)
WO (1) WO2004103996A1 (en)
ZA (1) ZA200508201B (en)

Cited By (110)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2005080388A1 (en) 2004-02-20 2005-09-01 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
WO2005116054A1 (en) * 2004-05-25 2005-12-08 Boehringer Ingelheim International, Gmbh Process for preparing acyclic hcv protease inhibitors
WO2006007700A1 (en) * 2004-07-20 2006-01-26 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis c inhibitor dipeptide analogs
WO2007005838A2 (en) 2005-06-30 2007-01-11 Virobay, Inc. Hcv inhibitors
WO2007019674A1 (en) 2005-08-12 2007-02-22 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
EP1763531A1 (en) * 2004-06-28 2007-03-21 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis c inhibitor peptide analogs
WO2007009109A3 (en) * 2005-07-14 2007-06-07 Gilead Sciences Inc Antiviral compounds
US7323447B2 (en) 2005-02-08 2008-01-29 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7368452B2 (en) 2003-04-18 2008-05-06 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Quinoxalinyl macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
WO2008057209A1 (en) * 2006-10-27 2008-05-15 Merck & Co., Inc. Hcv ns3 protease inhibitors
WO2008070358A2 (en) * 2006-11-16 2008-06-12 Phenomix Corporation N-cyclopropyl-hydroxyproline-based tripeptidic hepatitis c serine protease inhibitors containing an isoindole, pyrrolopyridine, pyrrolopyrimidine or pyrrolopyrazine heterocycle in the side chain
US7449479B2 (en) 2002-05-20 2008-11-11 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
WO2009076173A2 (en) 2007-12-05 2009-06-18 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Fluorinated tripeptide hcv serine protease inhibitors
WO2009076747A1 (en) 2007-12-19 2009-06-25 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
EP2079480A2 (en) * 2006-10-24 2009-07-22 Merck & Co., Inc. Hcv ns3 protease inhibitors
US7592336B2 (en) 2005-05-10 2009-09-22 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7601686B2 (en) 2005-07-11 2009-10-13 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7608590B2 (en) 2004-01-30 2009-10-27 Medivir Ab HCV NS-3 serine protease inhibitors
WO2010033444A1 (en) * 2008-09-16 2010-03-25 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Crystalline forms of a 2-thiazolyl- 4-quinolinyl-oxy derivative, a potent hcv inhibitor
WO2010033443A1 (en) * 2008-09-17 2010-03-25 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Combination of hcv ns3 protease inhibitor with interferon and ribavirin
US7696242B2 (en) 2004-07-20 2010-04-13 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis C inhibitor peptide analogs
US7718612B2 (en) * 2007-08-02 2010-05-18 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Pyridazinonyl macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
WO2010059667A1 (en) * 2008-11-21 2010-05-27 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Pharmaceutical composition of a potent hcv inhibitor for oral administration
US7741281B2 (en) 2005-11-03 2010-06-22 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
WO2010080874A1 (en) 2009-01-07 2010-07-15 Scynexis, Inc. Cyclosporine derivative for use in the treatment of hcv and hiv infection
US7763584B2 (en) 2006-11-16 2010-07-27 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7767660B2 (en) 2006-12-20 2010-08-03 Istituto Di Richerche Di Biologia Molecolare P. Angeletti Spa Antiviral indoles
US7772183B2 (en) 2005-10-12 2010-08-10 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7772180B2 (en) 2006-11-09 2010-08-10 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7781422B2 (en) 2006-12-20 2010-08-24 Istituto Di Ricerche Di Biologia Molecolare P. Angeletti Spa Antiviral indoles
US7816348B2 (en) 2006-02-03 2010-10-19 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
WO2010132163A1 (en) 2009-05-13 2010-11-18 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Macrocyclic compounds as hepatitis c virus inhibitors
US7879797B2 (en) 2005-05-02 2011-02-01 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US7888464B2 (en) 2006-11-16 2011-02-15 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7897622B2 (en) 2006-08-17 2011-03-01 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
US7906619B2 (en) 2006-07-13 2011-03-15 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. 4-amino-4-oxobutanoyl peptides as inhibitors of viral replication
US7935670B2 (en) 2006-07-11 2011-05-03 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7939667B2 (en) 2003-05-21 2011-05-10 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis C inhibitor compounds
US7964560B2 (en) 2008-05-29 2011-06-21 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7973040B2 (en) 2008-07-22 2011-07-05 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Macrocyclic quinoxaline compounds as HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US7989438B2 (en) 2007-07-17 2011-08-02 Istituto Di Ricerche Di Biologia Molecolare P. Angeletti Spa Therapeutic compounds
US8003604B2 (en) 2006-11-16 2011-08-23 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
EP2361925A1 (en) * 2003-10-10 2011-08-31 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors of serine proteases, particularly HCV NS3-NS4A protease
EP2364984A1 (en) 2005-08-26 2011-09-14 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors of serine proteases
US8044087B2 (en) 2008-09-29 2011-10-25 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8044023B2 (en) 2008-05-29 2011-10-25 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
EP2399575A2 (en) 2006-08-11 2011-12-28 INSERM (Institut National de la Santé et de la Recherche Médicale) Methods, uses and compositions for treatment of an infection by a virus of the family of flaviviridae through the farnesoid X receptor (FXR) inhibition
US8101595B2 (en) 2006-12-20 2012-01-24 Istituto di Ricerche di Biologia Molecolare P. Angletti SpA Antiviral indoles
US20120059033A1 (en) * 2010-03-11 2012-03-08 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Crystalline Salts of a Potent HCV Inhibitor
US8138164B2 (en) 2006-10-24 2012-03-20 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8148399B2 (en) 2005-07-29 2012-04-03 Tibotec Pharmaceuticals Ltd. Macrocyclic inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US8163693B2 (en) 2007-09-24 2012-04-24 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Urea-containing peptides as inhibitors of viral replication
US8163921B2 (en) 2008-04-16 2012-04-24 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8178520B2 (en) 2006-05-15 2012-05-15 Istituto Di Ricerche Di Biologia Molecolare P. Angeletti Spa Macrocyclic compounds as antiviral agents
US8178491B2 (en) 2007-06-29 2012-05-15 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Antiviral compounds
KR20120059481A (en) * 2009-07-07 2012-06-08 베링거 인겔하임 인터내셔날 게엠베하 Pharmaceutical composition for a hepatitis c viral protease inhibitor
US8202996B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2012-06-19 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Crystalline forms of N-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-3-methyl-L-valyl-(4R)-4-((7-chloro-4-methoxy-1-isoquinolinyl)oxy)-N- ((1R,2S)-1-((cyclopropylsulfonyl)carbamoyl)-2-vinylcyclopropyl)-L-prolinamide
US8207341B2 (en) 2008-09-04 2012-06-26 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Process or synthesizing substituted isoquinolines
US8216999B2 (en) 2005-07-20 2012-07-10 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8242140B2 (en) 2007-08-03 2012-08-14 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
WO2012107589A1 (en) 2011-02-11 2012-08-16 INSERM (Institut National de la Santé et de la Recherche Médicale) Methods and pharmaceutical compositions for the treatment and prevention of hcv infections
US8278322B2 (en) 2005-08-01 2012-10-02 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8283310B2 (en) 2008-12-15 2012-10-09 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
EP2512477A1 (en) * 2009-12-18 2012-10-24 Boehringer Ingelheim International GmbH Hcv combination therapy
US8314062B2 (en) 2006-06-23 2012-11-20 Instituto Di Ricerche Di Biologia Molecolare P. Angeletti S.P.A. Macrocyclic compounds as antiviral agents
US8314141B2 (en) 1996-10-18 2012-11-20 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors of serine proteases, particularly hepatitis C virus NS3 protease
US8324417B2 (en) 2009-08-19 2012-12-04 Virobay, Inc. Process for the preparation of (S)-2-amino-5-cyclopropyl-4,4-difluoropentanoic acid and alkyl esters and acid salts thereof
US8343477B2 (en) 2006-11-01 2013-01-01 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US8377874B2 (en) 2006-10-27 2013-02-19 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8377873B2 (en) 2006-10-24 2013-02-19 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8420596B2 (en) 2008-09-11 2013-04-16 Abbott Laboratories Macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
US8435984B2 (en) 2007-02-26 2013-05-07 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Tertiary amine substituted peptides useful as inhibitors of HCV replication
US8461107B2 (en) 2008-04-28 2013-06-11 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8513186B2 (en) 2007-06-29 2013-08-20 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Antiviral compounds
EP2631238A1 (en) 2007-02-27 2013-08-28 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Spirocyclic inhibitors of serine proteases for the treatment of hcv infections
US8563505B2 (en) 2008-09-29 2013-10-22 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8591878B2 (en) 2008-02-25 2013-11-26 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Therapeutic compounds
US8614180B2 (en) 2008-12-10 2013-12-24 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. 4-amino-4-oxobutanoyl peptides as inhibitors of viral replication
US8691757B2 (en) 2011-06-15 2014-04-08 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8778877B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2014-07-15 Celgene Avilomics Research, Inc. HCV protease inhibitors and uses thereof
TWI449711B (en) * 2005-06-30 2014-08-21 Virobay Inc Hcv inhibitors
US8822496B2 (en) 2009-10-30 2014-09-02 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Dosage regimens for HCV combination therapy
US8828930B2 (en) 2009-07-30 2014-09-09 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Hepatitis C virus NS3 protease inhibitors
US8927569B2 (en) 2007-07-19 2015-01-06 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Macrocyclic compounds as antiviral agents
US8937041B2 (en) 2010-12-30 2015-01-20 Abbvie, Inc. Macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
US8951964B2 (en) 2010-12-30 2015-02-10 Abbvie Inc. Phenanthridine macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
US8957203B2 (en) 2011-05-05 2015-02-17 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8993595B2 (en) 2009-04-08 2015-03-31 Idenix Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Macrocyclic serine protease inhibitors
US9006423B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2015-04-14 Achillion Pharmaceuticals Inc. Process for making a 4-amino-4-oxobutanoyl peptide cyclic analogue, an inhibitor of viral replication, and intermediates thereof
US9085607B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2015-07-21 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. ACH-0142684 sodium salt polymorph, composition including the same, and method of manufacture thereof
KR20150095903A (en) * 2012-12-21 2015-08-21 길리애드 사이언시즈, 인코포레이티드 Substituted pyridine-2-carboxamide compounds as apoptosis signal-regulating kinase inhibitors
US9115175B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2015-08-25 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Processes for Producing sovaprevir
US9163061B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2015-10-20 Celgene Avilomics Research, Inc. HCV protease inhibitors and uses thereof
WO2015192077A1 (en) * 2014-06-12 2015-12-17 The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Services Heterocyclic compounds and methods of use thereof
US9227952B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2016-01-05 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Sovaprevir polymorphs and methods of manufacture thereof
US9284307B2 (en) 2009-08-05 2016-03-15 Idenix Pharmaceuticals Llc Macrocyclic serine protease inhibitors
US9334279B2 (en) 2012-11-02 2016-05-10 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9333204B2 (en) 2014-01-03 2016-05-10 Abbvie Inc. Solid antiviral dosage forms
EP3020723A1 (en) 2010-09-21 2016-05-18 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Macrocyclic proline derived hcv serine protease inhibitors
US9353100B2 (en) 2011-02-10 2016-05-31 Idenix Pharmaceuticals Llc Macrocyclic serine protease inhibitors, pharmaceutical compositions thereof, and their use for treating HCV infections
US9409943B2 (en) 2012-11-05 2016-08-09 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9499550B2 (en) 2012-10-19 2016-11-22 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9580463B2 (en) 2013-03-07 2017-02-28 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9598433B2 (en) 2012-11-02 2017-03-21 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9643999B2 (en) 2012-11-02 2017-05-09 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9694086B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2017-07-04 Celgene Car Llc HCV protease inhibitors and uses thereof
US9732076B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2017-08-15 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Solid oral dosage formulation of HCV inhibitor in the amorphous state
CN108610301A (en) * 2016-12-12 2018-10-02 中山大学 A kind of chiral fragrant miscellaneous amine derivant and its synthetic method and application
US10201541B1 (en) 2011-05-17 2019-02-12 Abbvie Inc. Compositions and methods for treating HCV
US12083099B2 (en) 2020-10-28 2024-09-10 Accencio LLC Methods of treating symptoms of coronavirus infection with viral protease inhibitors

Families Citing this family (57)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
SV2003000617A (en) 2000-08-31 2003-01-13 Lilly Co Eli INHIBITORS OF PROTEASA PEPTIDOMIMETICA REF. X-14912M
US7119072B2 (en) * 2002-01-30 2006-10-10 Boehringer Ingelheim (Canada) Ltd. Macrocyclic peptides active against the hepatitis C virus
US20050075279A1 (en) * 2002-10-25 2005-04-07 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Macrocyclic peptides active against the hepatitis C virus
MY148123A (en) 2003-09-05 2013-02-28 Vertex Pharma Inhibitors of serine proteases, particularly hcv ns3-ns4a protease
PE20050431A1 (en) * 2003-09-22 2005-07-19 Boehringer Ingelheim Int MACROCYCLIC PEPTIDES ACTIVE AGAINST HEPATITIS C VIRUS
US7132504B2 (en) * 2003-11-12 2006-11-07 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
ES2358333T3 (en) * 2004-01-21 2011-05-09 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh MACROCYCLIC PEPTIDES WITH ACTION AGAINST THE VIRUS OF HEPATITIS C.
CA2556917C (en) 2004-03-15 2013-07-09 Boehringer Ingelheim International, Gmbh Process for preparing macrocyclic compounds
CN101072575A (en) 2004-10-01 2007-11-14 威特克斯医药股份有限公司 Hcv ns3-ns4a protease inhibition
MY141025A (en) 2004-10-29 2010-02-25 Vertex Pharma Dose forms
PL1863833T3 (en) * 2005-03-08 2014-03-31 Boehringer Ingelheim Int Process for preparing macrocyclic compounds
CN101277950B (en) * 2005-08-02 2013-03-27 弗特克斯药品有限公司 Inhibitors of serine proteases
CA2625419A1 (en) * 2005-11-03 2007-05-10 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Process for preparing substituted anisidines
US7642381B2 (en) * 2006-01-25 2010-01-05 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Two step process for preparing substituted anisidines
CN102614490A (en) 2006-02-27 2012-08-01 弗特克斯药品有限公司 Co-crystals having VX-950 and pharmaceutical compositions comprising the same
WO2007109080A2 (en) 2006-03-16 2007-09-27 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Deuterated hepatitis c protease inhibitors
CA2679426A1 (en) * 2007-02-27 2008-09-04 Luc Farmer Inhibitors of serine proteases
ATE542815T1 (en) * 2007-02-27 2012-02-15 Vertex Pharma COCRYSTALS AND PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS THEREOF
JP5443360B2 (en) * 2007-08-30 2014-03-19 バーテックス ファーマシューティカルズ インコーポレイテッド Co-crystal and pharmaceutical composition containing the same
CA2708042A1 (en) * 2007-12-05 2009-06-11 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Quinoxalinyl derivatives
US8293705B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2012-10-23 Avila Therapeutics, Inc. HCV protease inhibitors and uses thereof
AU2009210789B2 (en) * 2008-02-04 2014-01-30 Idenix Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Macrocyclic serine protease inhibitors
AU2014201788B2 (en) * 2008-09-16 2015-09-03 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Crystalline forms of a 2-thiazolyl- 4-quinolinyl-oxy derivative, a potent HCV inhibitor
JP2012502925A (en) * 2008-09-23 2012-02-02 ベーリンガー インゲルハイム インターナショナル ゲゼルシャフト ミット ベシュレンクテル ハフツング Hepatitis C inhibitor compound
KR20110114582A (en) 2008-12-19 2011-10-19 길리애드 사이언시즈, 인코포레이티드 Hcv ns3 protease inhibitors
JP2012517478A (en) 2009-02-12 2012-08-02 バーテックス ファーマシューティカルズ インコーポレイテッド HCV combination therapy comprising pegylated interferon, ribavirin and telaprevir
WO2010107965A1 (en) 2009-03-19 2010-09-23 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Process for preparing sulfonyl quinolines
TR201109333T1 (en) * 2009-03-26 2012-01-23 Daewoong Pharmaceutical Co. Ltd. New crystal forms of adefovir dipivoxil and their preparation processes.
EP2427434B1 (en) 2009-05-05 2017-05-31 Boehringer Ingelheim International GmbH Process for preparing bromo-substituted quinolines
US8232246B2 (en) * 2009-06-30 2012-07-31 Abbott Laboratories Anti-viral compounds
WO2011049908A2 (en) * 2009-10-19 2011-04-28 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Bismacrokyclic compounds as hepatitis c virus inhibitors
CA2788348A1 (en) 2010-01-29 2011-08-04 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Therapies for treating hepatitis c virus infection
WO2011156545A1 (en) 2010-06-09 2011-12-15 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Viral dynamic model for hcv combination therapy
AR082215A1 (en) 2010-07-14 2012-11-21 Vertex Pharma PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION NICE TO THE PALATE
MX2013003060A (en) 2010-09-30 2013-05-30 Boehringer Ingelheim Int Combination therapy for treating hcv infection.
EA201390532A1 (en) * 2010-10-08 2013-09-30 Новартис Аг COMPOSITIONS OF NS3 SULFAMIDE INHIBITORS CONTAINING VITAMIN E
US10873190B2 (en) 2010-11-19 2020-12-22 Tseng-Lu Chien Desktop or floor LED lighting device has USB-port(s)
US10873191B2 (en) 2010-11-19 2020-12-22 Tseng-Lu Chien Desk top alarm or time or LED lighting device has USB-port(s)
WO2012109646A1 (en) 2011-02-11 2012-08-16 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Treatment of hcv in hiv infection patients
EP2723337A1 (en) 2011-06-23 2014-04-30 Panmed Ltd. Treatment of hepatitis c virus
ES2527544T1 (en) 2011-10-21 2015-01-26 Abbvie Inc. Mono treatment (PSI-7977) or combination with ADF for use in the treatment of HCV
US8466159B2 (en) 2011-10-21 2013-06-18 Abbvie Inc. Methods for treating HCV
AR088463A1 (en) 2011-10-21 2014-06-11 Abbvie Inc METHODS FOR HCV TREATMENT
US8492386B2 (en) 2011-10-21 2013-07-23 Abbvie Inc. Methods for treating HCV
WO2013074386A2 (en) 2011-11-15 2013-05-23 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Hcv ns3 protease inhibitors
CN104244926A (en) 2012-01-12 2014-12-24 勃林格殷格翰国际有限公司 Stabilized pharmaceutical formulations of a potent HCV inhibitor
WO2013116339A1 (en) 2012-01-31 2013-08-08 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated High potency formulations of vx-950
WO2013137869A1 (en) 2012-03-14 2013-09-19 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Combination therapy for treating hcv infection in an hcv-hiv coinfected patient population
WO2013147749A1 (en) 2012-03-27 2013-10-03 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Oral combination therapy for treating hcv infection in specific patient subgenotype populations
WO2013147750A1 (en) 2012-03-27 2013-10-03 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Oral combination therapy for treating hcv infection in specific patient sub-population
WO2013143581A1 (en) 2012-03-28 2013-10-03 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Combination therapy for treating hcv infection in specific patient subgenotype sub-population
UA119315C2 (en) 2012-07-03 2019-06-10 Гіліад Фармассет Елелсі Inhibitors of hepatitis c virus
JP5870001B2 (en) 2012-09-28 2016-02-24 株式会社吉野工業所 Blow molding apparatus and container manufacturing method
WO2014138374A1 (en) 2013-03-08 2014-09-12 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Oral combination therapy for treating hcv infection in specific patient sub-population
SG11201507223TA (en) 2013-03-15 2015-10-29 Gilead Sciences Inc Macrocyclic and bicyclic inhibitors of hepatitis c virus
WO2017189978A1 (en) 2016-04-28 2017-11-02 Emory University Alkyne containing nucleotide and nucleoside therapeutic compositions and uses related thereto
US12060148B2 (en) 2022-08-16 2024-08-13 Honeywell International Inc. Ground resonance detection and warning system and method

Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2000009543A2 (en) * 1998-08-10 2000-02-24 Boehringer Ingelheim (Canada) Ltd. Hepatitis c inhibitor tri-peptides

Family Cites Families (90)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US684806A (en) * 1900-03-08 1901-10-22 Filter & Brautechnische Maschinen Fabrik Akt Ges Vorm L A Enzinger Pressure-regulator for pumps.
AR205953A1 (en) * 1975-01-22 1976-06-15 Diamond Shamrock Corp PRODUCTION OF CARBONATES FROM METALS TO CALINES IN A MEMBRANE CELL
DE3481913D1 (en) 1983-04-27 1990-05-17 Ici America Inc PROLIN DERIVATIVES.
JPH01103993A (en) 1987-10-16 1989-04-21 Sumitomo Electric Ind Ltd Method for growing diamond single crystal
JPH01135478A (en) 1987-11-19 1989-05-29 Brother Ind Ltd Grinding tool
US5164402A (en) 1989-08-16 1992-11-17 Pfizer Inc Azabicyclo quinolone and naphthyridinone carboxylic acids
US5290405A (en) * 1991-05-24 1994-03-01 Ceramatec, Inc. NaOH production from ceramic electrolytic cell
JPH05155827A (en) 1991-12-09 1993-06-22 Banyu Pharmaceut Co Ltd Production of cis-2-aminocyclopropanecarboxylic acid derivative
AU689589B2 (en) 1994-06-02 1998-04-02 Hoechst Marion Roussel, Inc. Novel elastase inhibitors
DE4430601A1 (en) 1994-08-22 1996-02-29 Beiersdorf Ag Cell adhesion peptides for modifying the adhesion behavior of eukaryotic cells to one another
US6159938A (en) 1994-11-21 2000-12-12 Cortech, Inc. Serine protease inhibitors comprising α-keto heterocycles
DE4444893A1 (en) 1994-12-16 1996-06-20 Merck Patent Gmbh Peptides and synthetic cell membranes
GB9517022D0 (en) 1995-08-19 1995-10-25 Glaxo Group Ltd Medicaments
DE19600034C2 (en) 1996-01-02 2003-12-24 Degussa 1,1,2-Trisubstituted cyclopropane compounds, process for their preparation and dihydroxyethyl-substituted 1-amino-cyclopropane-1-carboxylic acid
US5633388A (en) 1996-03-29 1997-05-27 Viropharma Incorporated Compounds, compositions and methods for treatment of hepatitis C
WO1997043310A1 (en) 1996-05-10 1997-11-20 Schering Corporation Synthetic inhibitors of hepatitis c virus ns3 protease
EP2409985A3 (en) 1996-10-18 2013-05-01 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors de serine proteases, especially of the NS3 protease of the hepatitis C virus
GB9623908D0 (en) 1996-11-18 1997-01-08 Hoffmann La Roche Amino acid derivatives
AU7127298A (en) 1997-04-14 1998-11-11 Emory University Serine protease inhibitors
GB9707659D0 (en) 1997-04-16 1997-06-04 Peptide Therapeutics Ltd Hepatitis C NS3 Protease inhibitors
JPH10298151A (en) 1997-04-30 1998-11-10 Japan Energy Corp Hepatitis c virus protease inhibitor
JP2002512625A (en) 1997-05-29 2002-04-23 メルク エンド カンパニー インコーポレーテッド Heterocyclic amide compounds as cell adhesion inhibitors
JPH1135478A (en) 1997-07-17 1999-02-09 Soyaku Gijutsu Kenkyusho:Kk Antihepatitis c viral agent and specific inhibitor of protease ns3 containing organic extract from plant of family compuestas
US6767991B1 (en) 1997-08-11 2004-07-27 Boehringer Ingelheim (Canada) Ltd. Hepatitis C inhibitor peptides
ES2234144T3 (en) 1997-08-11 2005-06-16 Boehringer Ingelheim (Canada) Ltd. ANALOGS OF INHIBITING PEPTIDES OF HEPATITIS C.
ES2241157T3 (en) 1997-08-11 2005-10-16 Boehringer Ingelheim (Canada) Ltd. INHIBITING PEPTIDES OF HEPATITIS C.
JPH11127861A (en) 1997-10-29 1999-05-18 Japan Energy Corp Neutralized partial peptide of antibody against serine protease originated from hepatitis c virus
JP3612551B2 (en) 1997-11-07 2005-01-19 独立行政法人産業技術総合研究所 RNA molecule that inhibits NS3 protease of hepatitis C virus
SE9704543D0 (en) 1997-12-05 1997-12-05 Astra Ab New compounds
IT1299134B1 (en) 1998-02-02 2000-02-29 Angeletti P Ist Richerche Bio PROCEDURE FOR THE PRODUCTION OF PEPTIDES WITH PROTEAS INHIBITING THE NS3 PROTEASIS OF THE HCV VIRUS, PEPTIDES SO OBTAINABLE AND PEPTIDES
GB9806815D0 (en) 1998-03-30 1998-05-27 Hoffmann La Roche Amino acid derivatives
EP1066247B1 (en) 1998-03-31 2006-11-22 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors of serine proteases, particularly hepatitis c virus ns3 protease
JPH11292840A (en) 1998-04-06 1999-10-26 Soyaku Gijutsu Kenkyusho:Kk Norstatine derivative or its salt
US6455571B1 (en) 1998-04-23 2002-09-24 Abbott Laboratories Inhibitors of neuraminidases
GB9809664D0 (en) 1998-05-06 1998-07-01 Hoffmann La Roche a-Ketoamide derivatives
GB9812523D0 (en) 1998-06-10 1998-08-05 Angeletti P Ist Richerche Bio Peptide inhibitors of hepatitis c virus ns3 protease
AR022061A1 (en) 1998-08-10 2002-09-04 Boehringer Ingelheim Ca Ltd INHIBITING PEPTIDES OF HEPATITIS C, A PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION CONTAINING THEM, THE USE OF THE SAME TO PREPARE A PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION, THE USE OF AN INTERMEDIATE PRODUCT FOR THE PREPARATION OF THESE PEPTIDES AND A PROCEDURE FOR THE PREPARATION OF ANOGRAPH .
WO2000020400A1 (en) 1998-10-05 2000-04-13 Axys Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Novel compounds and compositions for treating hepatitis c infections
US6277830B1 (en) 1998-10-16 2001-08-21 Schering Corporation 5′-amino acid esters of ribavirin and the use of same to treat hepatitis C with interferon
GB9825946D0 (en) 1998-11-26 1999-01-20 Angeletti P Ist Richerche Bio Pharmaceutical compounds for the inhibition of hepatitis C virus NS3 protease
UA74546C2 (en) 1999-04-06 2006-01-16 Boehringer Ingelheim Ca Ltd Macrocyclic peptides having activity relative to hepatitis c virus, a pharmaceutical composition and use of the pharmaceutical composition
US6608027B1 (en) 1999-04-06 2003-08-19 Boehringer Ingelheim (Canada) Ltd Macrocyclic peptides active against the hepatitis C virus
AU5920400A (en) 1999-07-07 2001-01-22 Du Pont Pharmaceuticals Company Cell-based assay systems for examining hcv ns3 protease activity
EP1206449A1 (en) 1999-07-26 2002-05-22 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Lactam inhibitors of hepatitis c virus ns3 protease
EP1206568A2 (en) 1999-08-30 2002-05-22 K.U. Leuven Research & Development Target for antiparasitic agents and inhibitors thereof
JP2001103993A (en) 1999-10-05 2001-04-17 Japan Energy Corp Cyclic peptide and serine protease inhibitor
US6222241B1 (en) * 1999-10-29 2001-04-24 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc. Method and system for reducing ARC layer removal by providing a capping layer for the ARC layer
GB9925955D0 (en) 1999-11-02 1999-12-29 Angeletti P Ist Richerche Bio Hcv n33 protease inhibitors
CA2390349A1 (en) 1999-12-03 2001-06-07 Bristol-Myers Squibb Pharma Company Alpha-ketoamide inhibitors of hepatitis c virus ns3 protease
AU2001234837A1 (en) 2000-02-08 2001-08-20 Schering Corporation Azapeptides useful in the treatment of hepatitis c
EP1261611A2 (en) 2000-02-29 2002-12-04 Bristol-Myers Squibb Pharma Company Inhibitors of hepatitis c virus ns3 protease
IL152022A0 (en) 2000-04-03 2003-04-10 Vertex Pharma Compounds useful as protease inhibitors and pharmaceutical compositions containing the same
KR20030036152A (en) 2000-04-05 2003-05-09 쉐링 코포레이션 Macrocyclic NS3-serine protease inhibitors of hepatitis C virus comprising N-cyclic P2 moieties
NZ521456A (en) 2000-04-19 2004-07-30 Schering Corp Macrocyclic NS3-Serine protease inhibitors of hepatitis C virus comprising alkyl and aryl alanine P2 moieties
AR034127A1 (en) 2000-07-21 2004-02-04 Schering Corp IMIDAZOLIDINONES AS INHIBITORS OF NS3-SERINA PROTEASA OF THE HEPATITIS C VIRUS, PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION, A METHOD FOR THEIR PREPARATION, AND THE USE OF THE SAME FOR THE MANUFACTURE OF A MEDICINAL PRODUCT
WO2002008251A2 (en) 2000-07-21 2002-01-31 Corvas International, Inc. Peptides as ns3-serine protease inhibitors of hepatitis c virus
AR029851A1 (en) 2000-07-21 2003-07-16 Dendreon Corp NEW PEPTIDES AS INHIBITORS OF NS3-SERINA PROTEASA DEL VIRUS DE HEPATITIS C
HUP0303358A3 (en) 2000-07-21 2005-10-28 Schering Corp Novel peptides as ns3-serine protease inhibitors of hepatitis c virus and pharmaceutical compositions containing them
DK1385870T3 (en) 2000-07-21 2010-07-05 Schering Corp Peptides as inhibitors of NS3 serine protease from hepatitis C virus
SV2003000617A (en) 2000-08-31 2003-01-13 Lilly Co Eli INHIBITORS OF PROTEASA PEPTIDOMIMETICA REF. X-14912M
US6846806B2 (en) 2000-10-23 2005-01-25 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Peptide inhibitors of Hepatitis C virus NS3 protein
EP1337550B1 (en) 2000-11-20 2006-05-24 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis c tripeptide inhibitors
GB0107924D0 (en) 2001-03-29 2001-05-23 Angeletti P Ist Richerche Bio Inhibitor of hepatitis C virus NS3 protease
US6867185B2 (en) 2001-12-20 2005-03-15 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
CA2369711A1 (en) 2002-01-30 2003-07-30 Boehringer Ingelheim (Canada) Ltd. Macrocyclic peptides active against the hepatitis c virus
CA2474156C (en) 2002-02-01 2011-09-20 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Tripeptides having a hydroxyproline ether of a substituted quinoline for the inhibition of ns3 (hepatitis c)
US6642204B2 (en) * 2002-02-01 2003-11-04 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis C inhibitor tri-peptides
US7091184B2 (en) 2002-02-01 2006-08-15 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis C inhibitor tri-peptides
CA2370396A1 (en) 2002-02-01 2003-08-01 Boehringer Ingelheim (Canada) Ltd. Hepatitis c inhibitor tri-peptides
CA2369970A1 (en) 2002-02-01 2003-08-01 Boehringer Ingelheim (Canada) Ltd. Hepatitis c inhibitor tri-peptides
AU2003299519A1 (en) 2002-05-20 2004-05-04 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis c virus inhibitors
AU2003301959A1 (en) 2002-05-20 2004-06-03 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Substituted cycloalkyl p1' hepatitis c virus inhibitors
WO2003099316A1 (en) 2002-05-20 2003-12-04 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Heterocyclicsulfonamide hepatitis c virus inhibitors
MY140680A (en) 2002-05-20 2010-01-15 Bristol Myers Squibb Co Hepatitis c virus inhibitors
US20040033959A1 (en) 2002-07-19 2004-02-19 Boehringer Ingelheim Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Pharmaceutical compositions for hepatitis C viral protease inhibitors
WO2004101605A1 (en) * 2003-03-05 2004-11-25 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis c inhibiting compounds
ATE486889T1 (en) 2003-03-05 2010-11-15 Boehringer Ingelheim Int PEPTIDE ANALOGUES WITH INHIBITORY EFFECT ON HEPATITIS C
UY28323A1 (en) * 2003-05-21 2004-12-31 Boehringer Ingelheim Int INHIBITING COMPOUNDS OF HEPATITIS C
PE20050431A1 (en) 2003-09-22 2005-07-19 Boehringer Ingelheim Int MACROCYCLIC PEPTIDES ACTIVE AGAINST HEPATITIS C VIRUS
US7132504B2 (en) 2003-11-12 2006-11-07 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
EP1702089A2 (en) * 2003-12-11 2006-09-20 American Pacific Corporation Electrolytic method to make alkali alcoholates using ceramic ion conducting solid membranes
WO2005073195A2 (en) * 2004-01-30 2005-08-11 Medivir Ab Hcv ns-3 serine protease inhibitors
JP5156374B2 (en) 2004-05-25 2013-03-06 ベーリンガー インゲルハイム インターナショナル ゲゼルシャフト ミット ベシュレンクテル ハフツング Method for preparing acyclic HCV protease inhibitor
RU2004119195A (en) 2004-06-24 2005-12-10 Дмитрий Александрович Гертнер (RU) METHOD FOR NON-CONTACT, GUARANTEED DELIVERY OF GOODS TO END USER AND SYSTEM FOR ITS IMPLEMENTATION
WO2006000085A1 (en) 2004-06-28 2006-01-05 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis c inhibitor peptide analogs
WO2006007708A1 (en) 2004-07-20 2006-01-26 Boehringer Engelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis c inhibitor peptide analogs
UY29016A1 (en) 2004-07-20 2006-02-24 Boehringer Ingelheim Int ANALOGS OF INHIBITING DIPEPTIDES OF HEPATITIS C
WO2008124047A1 (en) * 2007-04-03 2008-10-16 Ceramatec, Inc. Electrochemical process to recycle aqueous alkali chemicals using ceramic ion conducting solid membranes
US20090090638A1 (en) * 2007-10-05 2009-04-09 Kelly Michael T Processes and reactors for alkali metal production
US8246863B2 (en) * 2009-06-26 2012-08-21 Ceramatec, Inc. Alkali metal super ionic conducting ceramic

Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2000009543A2 (en) * 1998-08-10 2000-02-24 Boehringer Ingelheim (Canada) Ltd. Hepatitis c inhibitor tri-peptides

Cited By (202)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US8314141B2 (en) 1996-10-18 2012-11-20 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors of serine proteases, particularly hepatitis C virus NS3 protease
US9636375B2 (en) 2002-05-20 2017-05-02 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8889871B2 (en) 2002-05-20 2014-11-18 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7449479B2 (en) 2002-05-20 2008-11-11 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8507722B2 (en) 2002-05-20 2013-08-13 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8299094B2 (en) 2002-05-20 2012-10-30 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7915291B2 (en) 2002-05-20 2011-03-29 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9227940B2 (en) 2002-05-20 2016-01-05 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8710229B2 (en) 2002-05-20 2014-04-29 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7368452B2 (en) 2003-04-18 2008-05-06 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Quinoxalinyl macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
US7939667B2 (en) 2003-05-21 2011-05-10 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis C inhibitor compounds
US8067438B2 (en) 2003-05-21 2011-11-29 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis C inhibitor compounds
EP2361925A1 (en) * 2003-10-10 2011-08-31 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors of serine proteases, particularly HCV NS3-NS4A protease
US8039623B2 (en) 2003-10-10 2011-10-18 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors of serine proteases, particularly HCV NS3-NS4A protease
US7671032B2 (en) 2004-01-30 2010-03-02 Medivir Ab HCV NS-3 serine protease inhibitors
US7608590B2 (en) 2004-01-30 2009-10-27 Medivir Ab HCV NS-3 serine protease inhibitors
US10172846B2 (en) 2004-01-30 2019-01-08 Medivir Ab HCV NS-3 serine protease inhibitors
WO2005080388A1 (en) 2004-02-20 2005-09-01 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
EP2626354A1 (en) 2004-02-20 2013-08-14 Boehringer Ingelheim International GmbH Viral polymerase inhibitors
US8101765B2 (en) 2004-05-25 2012-01-24 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Process for preparing acyclic HCV protease inhibitors
US8017771B2 (en) 2004-05-25 2011-09-13 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Process for preparing acyclic HCV protease inhibitors
WO2005116054A1 (en) * 2004-05-25 2005-12-08 Boehringer Ingelheim International, Gmbh Process for preparing acyclic hcv protease inhibitors
US7514557B2 (en) 2004-05-25 2009-04-07 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Process for preparing acyclic HCV protease inhibitors
EP1763531A4 (en) * 2004-06-28 2009-07-01 Boehringer Ingelheim Int Hepatitis c inhibitor peptide analogs
JP2008504240A (en) * 2004-06-28 2008-02-14 ベーリンガー インゲルハイム インターナショナル ゲゼルシャフト ミット ベシュレンクテル ハフツング Hepatitis C inhibitor peptide analog
US7705146B2 (en) 2004-06-28 2010-04-27 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis C inhibitor peptide analogs
JP4914348B2 (en) * 2004-06-28 2012-04-11 ベーリンガー インゲルハイム インターナショナル ゲゼルシャフト ミット ベシュレンクテル ハフツング Hepatitis C inhibitor peptide analog
EP1763531A1 (en) * 2004-06-28 2007-03-21 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis c inhibitor peptide analogs
US7767818B2 (en) 2004-07-20 2010-08-03 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis C inhibitor dipeptide analogs
US7696242B2 (en) 2004-07-20 2010-04-13 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis C inhibitor peptide analogs
WO2006007700A1 (en) * 2004-07-20 2006-01-26 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Hepatitis c inhibitor dipeptide analogs
US7323447B2 (en) 2005-02-08 2008-01-29 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7879797B2 (en) 2005-05-02 2011-02-01 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US7592336B2 (en) 2005-05-10 2009-09-22 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
JP2009500353A (en) * 2005-06-30 2009-01-08 ビロベイ,インコーポレイティド HCV inhibitor
WO2007005838A2 (en) 2005-06-30 2007-01-11 Virobay, Inc. Hcv inhibitors
US8518874B2 (en) 2005-06-30 2013-08-27 Virobay, Inc. HCV inhibitors
TWI449711B (en) * 2005-06-30 2014-08-21 Virobay Inc Hcv inhibitors
JP2012176973A (en) * 2005-06-30 2012-09-13 Virobay Inc Hcv inhibitor
EP1906945B1 (en) * 2005-06-30 2015-08-05 Virobay, Inc. Hcv inhibitors
US7601686B2 (en) 2005-07-11 2009-10-13 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
WO2007009109A3 (en) * 2005-07-14 2007-06-07 Gilead Sciences Inc Antiviral compounds
KR101345008B1 (en) 2005-07-14 2013-12-31 길리애드 사이언시즈, 인코포레이티드 Antiviral compounds
US8216999B2 (en) 2005-07-20 2012-07-10 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8349869B2 (en) 2005-07-29 2013-01-08 Tibotec Pharmaceuticals Ltd. Macrocylic inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US8741926B2 (en) 2005-07-29 2014-06-03 Janssen R&D Ireland Macrocyclic inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US9040562B2 (en) 2005-07-29 2015-05-26 Janssen R&D Ireland Macrocyclic inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US9856265B2 (en) 2005-07-29 2018-01-02 Janssen Sciences Ireland Uc Macrocyclic inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US9353103B2 (en) 2005-07-29 2016-05-31 Janssen Sciences Ireland Uc Macrocyclic inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US8153800B2 (en) 2005-07-29 2012-04-10 Tibotec Pharmaceuticals Ltd. Macrocyclic inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US8148399B2 (en) 2005-07-29 2012-04-03 Tibotec Pharmaceuticals Ltd. Macrocyclic inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US9623022B2 (en) 2005-07-29 2017-04-18 Janssen Sciences Ireland Uc Macrocyclic inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US8754106B2 (en) 2005-07-29 2014-06-17 Janssen R&D Ireland Macrocyclic inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US8278322B2 (en) 2005-08-01 2012-10-02 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
WO2007019674A1 (en) 2005-08-12 2007-02-22 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
EP2364984A1 (en) 2005-08-26 2011-09-14 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors of serine proteases
EP2366704A1 (en) 2005-08-26 2011-09-21 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors of serine proteases
US7772183B2 (en) 2005-10-12 2010-08-10 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7741281B2 (en) 2005-11-03 2010-06-22 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7816348B2 (en) 2006-02-03 2010-10-19 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
US8178520B2 (en) 2006-05-15 2012-05-15 Istituto Di Ricerche Di Biologia Molecolare P. Angeletti Spa Macrocyclic compounds as antiviral agents
US8314062B2 (en) 2006-06-23 2012-11-20 Instituto Di Ricerche Di Biologia Molecolare P. Angeletti S.P.A. Macrocyclic compounds as antiviral agents
US7935670B2 (en) 2006-07-11 2011-05-03 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8785378B2 (en) 2006-07-13 2014-07-22 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Macrocyclic peptides as inhibitors of viral replication
US9610317B2 (en) 2006-07-13 2017-04-04 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. 4-amino-4-oxobutanoyl peptides as inhibitors of viral replication
US7906619B2 (en) 2006-07-13 2011-03-15 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. 4-amino-4-oxobutanoyl peptides as inhibitors of viral replication
US9233136B2 (en) 2006-07-13 2016-01-12 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. 4-amino-4-oxobutanoyl peptides as inhibitors of viral replication
EP2399575A2 (en) 2006-08-11 2011-12-28 INSERM (Institut National de la Santé et de la Recherche Médicale) Methods, uses and compositions for treatment of an infection by a virus of the family of flaviviridae through the farnesoid X receptor (FXR) inhibition
EP2399988A2 (en) 2006-08-11 2011-12-28 INSERM (Institut National de la Santé et de la Recherche Médicale) Cell culture system for replication of HCV through the farnesoid X receptor (FXR) activation or inhibition and diagnostic method for HCV infection
US7897622B2 (en) 2006-08-17 2011-03-01 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
EP2079480A2 (en) * 2006-10-24 2009-07-22 Merck & Co., Inc. Hcv ns3 protease inhibitors
US8138164B2 (en) 2006-10-24 2012-03-20 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8309540B2 (en) 2006-10-24 2012-11-13 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8377873B2 (en) 2006-10-24 2013-02-19 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
EP2079480A4 (en) * 2006-10-24 2011-06-15 Merck Sharp & Dohme Hcv ns3 protease inhibitors
US9738661B2 (en) 2006-10-27 2017-08-22 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8377874B2 (en) 2006-10-27 2013-02-19 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
KR20090075874A (en) * 2006-10-27 2009-07-09 머크 앤드 캄파니 인코포레이티드 HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
KR101615500B1 (en) 2006-10-27 2016-04-27 머크 샤프 앤드 돔 코포레이션 HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
WO2008057209A1 (en) * 2006-10-27 2008-05-15 Merck & Co., Inc. Hcv ns3 protease inhibitors
RU2468029C2 (en) * 2006-10-27 2012-11-27 Иституто Ди Ричерке Ди Биолоджиа Молеколаре П.Анджелетти С.П.А. Hcv ns3 ptotease inhibitors
US8343477B2 (en) 2006-11-01 2013-01-01 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Inhibitors of hepatitis C virus
US7772180B2 (en) 2006-11-09 2010-08-10 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8003604B2 (en) 2006-11-16 2011-08-23 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7888464B2 (en) 2006-11-16 2011-02-15 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
WO2008070358A2 (en) * 2006-11-16 2008-06-12 Phenomix Corporation N-cyclopropyl-hydroxyproline-based tripeptidic hepatitis c serine protease inhibitors containing an isoindole, pyrrolopyridine, pyrrolopyrimidine or pyrrolopyrazine heterocycle in the side chain
WO2008070358A3 (en) * 2006-11-16 2008-11-06 Phenomix Corp N-cyclopropyl-hydroxyproline-based tripeptidic hepatitis c serine protease inhibitors containing an isoindole, pyrrolopyridine, pyrrolopyrimidine or pyrrolopyrazine heterocycle in the side chain
US7763584B2 (en) 2006-11-16 2010-07-27 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8101595B2 (en) 2006-12-20 2012-01-24 Istituto di Ricerche di Biologia Molecolare P. Angletti SpA Antiviral indoles
US7781422B2 (en) 2006-12-20 2010-08-24 Istituto Di Ricerche Di Biologia Molecolare P. Angeletti Spa Antiviral indoles
US7767660B2 (en) 2006-12-20 2010-08-03 Istituto Di Richerche Di Biologia Molecolare P. Angeletti Spa Antiviral indoles
US8435984B2 (en) 2007-02-26 2013-05-07 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Tertiary amine substituted peptides useful as inhibitors of HCV replication
EP2631238A1 (en) 2007-02-27 2013-08-28 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Spirocyclic inhibitors of serine proteases for the treatment of hcv infections
US8178491B2 (en) 2007-06-29 2012-05-15 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Antiviral compounds
US8809267B2 (en) 2007-06-29 2014-08-19 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Antiviral compounds
US8513186B2 (en) 2007-06-29 2013-08-20 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Antiviral compounds
US8809266B2 (en) 2007-06-29 2014-08-19 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Antiviral compounds
US7989438B2 (en) 2007-07-17 2011-08-02 Istituto Di Ricerche Di Biologia Molecolare P. Angeletti Spa Therapeutic compounds
US8927569B2 (en) 2007-07-19 2015-01-06 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Macrocyclic compounds as antiviral agents
US7718612B2 (en) * 2007-08-02 2010-05-18 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Pyridazinonyl macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
US8242140B2 (en) 2007-08-03 2012-08-14 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
US8163693B2 (en) 2007-09-24 2012-04-24 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Urea-containing peptides as inhibitors of viral replication
WO2009076173A2 (en) 2007-12-05 2009-06-18 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Fluorinated tripeptide hcv serine protease inhibitors
US8476257B2 (en) 2007-12-19 2013-07-02 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
US8541402B2 (en) 2007-12-19 2013-09-24 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
US8912182B2 (en) 2007-12-19 2014-12-16 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
WO2009076747A1 (en) 2007-12-19 2009-06-25 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Viral polymerase inhibitors
US8778877B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2014-07-15 Celgene Avilomics Research, Inc. HCV protease inhibitors and uses thereof
US9163061B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2015-10-20 Celgene Avilomics Research, Inc. HCV protease inhibitors and uses thereof
US9694086B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2017-07-04 Celgene Car Llc HCV protease inhibitors and uses thereof
US9676785B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2017-06-13 Celgene Car Llc HCV protease inhibitors and uses thereof
US8202996B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2012-06-19 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Crystalline forms of N-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-3-methyl-L-valyl-(4R)-4-((7-chloro-4-methoxy-1-isoquinolinyl)oxy)-N- ((1R,2S)-1-((cyclopropylsulfonyl)carbamoyl)-2-vinylcyclopropyl)-L-prolinamide
US8338606B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2012-12-25 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Crystalline forms of N-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-3-methyl-L-valyl-(4R)-4-((7-chloro-4-methoxy-1-isoquinolinyl)oxy)-N-((1R,2S)-1-((cyclopropylsulfonyl)carbamoyl)-2-vinylcyclopropyl)-L-prolinamide
US8591878B2 (en) 2008-02-25 2013-11-26 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Therapeutic compounds
US8163921B2 (en) 2008-04-16 2012-04-24 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8461107B2 (en) 2008-04-28 2013-06-11 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8044023B2 (en) 2008-05-29 2011-10-25 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7964560B2 (en) 2008-05-29 2011-06-21 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US7973040B2 (en) 2008-07-22 2011-07-05 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Macrocyclic quinoxaline compounds as HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8080654B2 (en) 2008-07-22 2011-12-20 Insituto di Ricerche di Biologia Molecolare P. Angeletti SpA Macrocyclic quinoxaline compounds as HCV NS3 protease inhibitors
US8357806B2 (en) 2008-09-04 2013-01-22 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Process for synthesizing substituted isoquinolines
US8877929B2 (en) 2008-09-04 2014-11-04 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Process for synthesizing substituted isoquinolines
US8207341B2 (en) 2008-09-04 2012-06-26 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Process or synthesizing substituted isoquinolines
US9309279B2 (en) 2008-09-11 2016-04-12 Abbvie Inc. Macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
US8642538B2 (en) 2008-09-11 2014-02-04 Abbvie, Inc. Macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
US8420596B2 (en) 2008-09-11 2013-04-16 Abbott Laboratories Macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
EA018603B1 (en) * 2008-09-16 2013-09-30 Бёрингер Ингельхайм Интернациональ Гмбх Crystalline forms of a 2-thiazolyl- 4-quinolinyloxy derivative, a potent hcv inhibitor
US8232293B2 (en) 2008-09-16 2012-07-31 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Crystalline forms of a potent HCV inhibitor
KR20110059841A (en) * 2008-09-16 2011-06-07 베링거 인겔하임 인터내셔날 게엠베하 Crystalline forms of a 2-thiazolyl-4-quinolinyl-oxy derivative, a potent hcv inhibitor
WO2010033444A1 (en) * 2008-09-16 2010-03-25 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Crystalline forms of a 2-thiazolyl- 4-quinolinyl-oxy derivative, a potent hcv inhibitor
TWI471323B (en) * 2008-09-16 2015-02-01 Boehringer Ingelheim Int Crystalline forms of a potent hcv inhibitor
KR101653550B1 (en) * 2008-09-16 2016-09-02 베링거 인겔하임 인터내셔날 게엠베하 Crystalline forms of a 2-thiazolyl-4-quinolinyl-oxy derivative, a potent HCV inhibitor
AU2009293494B2 (en) * 2008-09-16 2014-04-24 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Crystalline forms of a 2-thiazolyl- 4-quinolinyl-oxy derivative, a potent HCV inhibitor
EP2687526A1 (en) * 2008-09-16 2014-01-22 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Crystalline forms of a 2-thiazolyl- 4-quinolinyl-oxy derivative, a potent HCV inhibitor
US8362035B2 (en) 2008-09-16 2013-01-29 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Crystalline forms of a potent HCV inhibitor
CN102159571A (en) * 2008-09-16 2011-08-17 贝林格尔.英格海姆国际有限公司 Crystalline forms of a 2-thiazolyl- 4-quinolinyl-oxy derivative, potent hcv inhibitor
CN102159571B (en) * 2008-09-16 2014-10-01 贝林格尔.英格海姆国际有限公司 Crystalline forms of a 2-thiazolyl- 4-quinolinyl-oxy derivative, potent hcv inhibitor
AU2009293493B2 (en) * 2008-09-17 2014-09-18 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Combination of HCV NS3 protease inhibitor with interferon and ribavirin
US8399484B2 (en) 2008-09-17 2013-03-19 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Combination therapy for treating HCV infection
WO2010033443A1 (en) * 2008-09-17 2010-03-25 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Combination of hcv ns3 protease inhibitor with interferon and ribavirin
EA019965B1 (en) * 2008-09-17 2014-07-30 Бёрингер Ингельхайм Интернациональ Гмбх Combination of hcv ns3 protease inhibitor with interferon and ribavirin
CN102159245B (en) * 2008-09-17 2013-07-24 贝林格尔.英格海姆国际有限公司 Combination of hcv ns3 protease inhibitor with interferon and ribavirin
US8563505B2 (en) 2008-09-29 2013-10-22 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8044087B2 (en) 2008-09-29 2011-10-25 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
WO2010059667A1 (en) * 2008-11-21 2010-05-27 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Pharmaceutical composition of a potent hcv inhibitor for oral administration
EA022272B1 (en) * 2008-11-21 2015-12-30 Бёрингер Ингельхайм Интернациональ Гмбх Pharmaceutical composition of a potent hcv inhibitor for oral administration
CN102223875A (en) * 2008-11-21 2011-10-19 贝林格尔.英格海姆国际有限公司 Pharmaceutical composition of a potent hcv inhibitor for oral administration
AU2009316755B2 (en) * 2008-11-21 2015-10-08 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Pharmaceutical composition of a potent HCV inhibitor for oral administration
US8614180B2 (en) 2008-12-10 2013-12-24 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. 4-amino-4-oxobutanoyl peptides as inhibitors of viral replication
US9133115B2 (en) 2008-12-10 2015-09-15 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. 4-amino-4-oxobutanoyl peptides as inhibitors of viral replication
US8283310B2 (en) 2008-12-15 2012-10-09 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
WO2010080874A1 (en) 2009-01-07 2010-07-15 Scynexis, Inc. Cyclosporine derivative for use in the treatment of hcv and hiv infection
US8993595B2 (en) 2009-04-08 2015-03-31 Idenix Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Macrocyclic serine protease inhibitors
WO2010132163A1 (en) 2009-05-13 2010-11-18 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Macrocyclic compounds as hepatitis c virus inhibitors
KR20120059481A (en) * 2009-07-07 2012-06-08 베링거 인겔하임 인터내셔날 게엠베하 Pharmaceutical composition for a hepatitis c viral protease inhibitor
US9034831B2 (en) 2009-07-07 2015-05-19 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Pharmaceutical composition for a hepatitis C viral protease inhibitor
KR101685941B1 (en) 2009-07-07 2016-12-13 베링거 인겔하임 인터내셔날 게엠베하 Pharmaceutical composition for a hepatitis C viral protease inhibitor
US8828930B2 (en) 2009-07-30 2014-09-09 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Hepatitis C virus NS3 protease inhibitors
US9284307B2 (en) 2009-08-05 2016-03-15 Idenix Pharmaceuticals Llc Macrocyclic serine protease inhibitors
US8324417B2 (en) 2009-08-19 2012-12-04 Virobay, Inc. Process for the preparation of (S)-2-amino-5-cyclopropyl-4,4-difluoropentanoic acid and alkyl esters and acid salts thereof
US8822496B2 (en) 2009-10-30 2014-09-02 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Dosage regimens for HCV combination therapy
AU2010333656B2 (en) * 2009-12-18 2015-08-27 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh HCV combination therapy
EP2512477A4 (en) * 2009-12-18 2013-07-10 Boehringer Ingelheim Int Hcv combination therapy
EP2512477A1 (en) * 2009-12-18 2012-10-24 Boehringer Ingelheim International GmbH Hcv combination therapy
CN102844315B (en) * 2010-03-11 2015-05-20 贝林格尔.英格海姆国际有限公司 Crystalline salts of potent HCV inhibitors
CN102844315A (en) * 2010-03-11 2012-12-26 贝林格尔.英格海姆国际有限公司 Crystalline salts of potent HCV inhibitors
US9382240B2 (en) 2010-03-11 2016-07-05 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Crystalline salts of a potent HCV inhibitor
US20120059033A1 (en) * 2010-03-11 2012-03-08 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Crystalline Salts of a Potent HCV Inhibitor
US8530497B2 (en) 2010-03-11 2013-09-10 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Crystalline salts of a potent HCV inhibitor
EP3020723A1 (en) 2010-09-21 2016-05-18 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Macrocyclic proline derived hcv serine protease inhibitors
US8951964B2 (en) 2010-12-30 2015-02-10 Abbvie Inc. Phenanthridine macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
US8937041B2 (en) 2010-12-30 2015-01-20 Abbvie, Inc. Macrocyclic hepatitis C serine protease inhibitors
US9353100B2 (en) 2011-02-10 2016-05-31 Idenix Pharmaceuticals Llc Macrocyclic serine protease inhibitors, pharmaceutical compositions thereof, and their use for treating HCV infections
WO2012107589A1 (en) 2011-02-11 2012-08-16 INSERM (Institut National de la Santé et de la Recherche Médicale) Methods and pharmaceutical compositions for the treatment and prevention of hcv infections
US9527885B2 (en) 2011-05-05 2016-12-27 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US8957203B2 (en) 2011-05-05 2015-02-17 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US10201541B1 (en) 2011-05-17 2019-02-12 Abbvie Inc. Compositions and methods for treating HCV
US10201584B1 (en) 2011-05-17 2019-02-12 Abbvie Inc. Compositions and methods for treating HCV
US8691757B2 (en) 2011-06-15 2014-04-08 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9499550B2 (en) 2012-10-19 2016-11-22 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9598433B2 (en) 2012-11-02 2017-03-21 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9643999B2 (en) 2012-11-02 2017-05-09 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9334279B2 (en) 2012-11-02 2016-05-10 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9409943B2 (en) 2012-11-05 2016-08-09 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
KR101712758B1 (en) 2012-12-21 2017-03-06 길리애드 사이언시즈, 인코포레이티드 Substituted pyridine-2-carboxamide compounds as apoptosis signal-regulating kinase inhibitors
KR20150095903A (en) * 2012-12-21 2015-08-21 길리애드 사이언시즈, 인코포레이티드 Substituted pyridine-2-carboxamide compounds as apoptosis signal-regulating kinase inhibitors
US9580463B2 (en) 2013-03-07 2017-02-28 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9115175B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2015-08-25 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Processes for Producing sovaprevir
US9481708B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2016-11-01 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Process for producing Sovaprevir
US9732076B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2017-08-15 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Solid oral dosage formulation of HCV inhibitor in the amorphous state
US9540346B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2017-01-10 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Sovaprevir polymorphs and methods of manufacture thereof
US9227952B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2016-01-05 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Sovaprevir polymorphs and methods of manufacture thereof
US9085607B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2015-07-21 Achillion Pharmaceuticals, Inc. ACH-0142684 sodium salt polymorph, composition including the same, and method of manufacture thereof
US9006423B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2015-04-14 Achillion Pharmaceuticals Inc. Process for making a 4-amino-4-oxobutanoyl peptide cyclic analogue, an inhibitor of viral replication, and intermediates thereof
US9744170B2 (en) 2014-01-03 2017-08-29 Abbvie Inc. Solid antiviral dosage forms
US10105365B2 (en) 2014-01-03 2018-10-23 Abbvie Inc. Solid antiviral dosage forms
US9333204B2 (en) 2014-01-03 2016-05-10 Abbvie Inc. Solid antiviral dosage forms
WO2015192077A1 (en) * 2014-06-12 2015-12-17 The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Services Heterocyclic compounds and methods of use thereof
US10202367B2 (en) 2014-06-12 2019-02-12 The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Services Heterocyclic compounds and methods of use thereof
CN108610301A (en) * 2016-12-12 2018-10-02 中山大学 A kind of chiral fragrant miscellaneous amine derivant and its synthetic method and application
CN108610301B (en) * 2016-12-12 2021-08-31 中山大学 Chiral aromatic heterocyclic amine derivative and synthesis method and application thereof
US12083099B2 (en) 2020-10-28 2024-09-10 Accencio LLC Methods of treating symptoms of coronavirus infection with viral protease inhibitors

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
UY28323A1 (en) 2004-12-31
AU2004240704B9 (en) 2009-10-22
CN103204903A (en) 2013-07-17
RS20050871A (en) 2007-08-03
ECSP056181A (en) 2006-04-19
MXPA05012545A (en) 2006-02-08
CO5630024A2 (en) 2006-04-28
TW200508220A (en) 2005-03-01
EA009295B1 (en) 2007-12-28
DE602004010137D1 (en) 2007-12-27
EP1654261A1 (en) 2006-05-10
AU2004240704A1 (en) 2004-12-02
EP1654261B1 (en) 2007-11-14
EA200501689A1 (en) 2006-06-30
BRPI0410456B1 (en) 2019-07-09
CN1791599A (en) 2006-06-21
HRP20080014T3 (en) 2008-02-29
ZA200508201B (en) 2007-02-28
DK1654261T3 (en) 2008-01-14
US8067438B2 (en) 2011-11-29
CA2522577A1 (en) 2004-12-02
CN103203010A (en) 2013-07-17
US20120269769A1 (en) 2012-10-25
BRPI0410456B8 (en) 2021-05-25
ME00382B (en) 2011-05-10
UA83046C2 (en) 2008-06-10
IL172013A (en) 2011-10-31
BRPI0410456A (en) 2006-06-06
US7939667B2 (en) 2011-05-10
JP4447603B2 (en) 2010-04-07
DE602004010137T2 (en) 2008-09-11
ES2297424T3 (en) 2008-05-01
KR101115294B1 (en) 2012-04-12
US20070243166A1 (en) 2007-10-18
AU2004240704B2 (en) 2009-08-20
JP2006528937A (en) 2006-12-28
PE20050204A1 (en) 2005-05-04
US20110177030A1 (en) 2011-07-21
US20120034187A1 (en) 2012-02-09
PL1654261T3 (en) 2008-04-30
NO20056047L (en) 2006-01-31
TWI327145B (en) 2010-07-11
US7585845B2 (en) 2009-09-08
MY143076A (en) 2011-02-28
NO332056B1 (en) 2012-06-11
CY1107200T1 (en) 2012-11-21
US20050020503A1 (en) 2005-01-27
RS51294B (en) 2010-12-31
CL2004001161A1 (en) 2005-04-08
ATE378334T1 (en) 2007-11-15
NZ544076A (en) 2009-04-30
MEP58308A (en) 2011-05-10
KR20060013671A (en) 2006-02-13
JP2010043129A (en) 2010-02-25
CA2522577C (en) 2011-04-26
PT1654261E (en) 2008-01-18

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
EP1654261B1 (en) Hepatitis c inhibitor compounds
EP1474423B1 (en) Heterocyclic tripeptides as hepatitis c inhibitors
US7091184B2 (en) Hepatitis C inhibitor tri-peptides
US7642235B2 (en) Macrocyclic peptides active against the hepatitis C virus
EP1474441B1 (en) Tripeptides having a hydroxyproline ether of a substituted quinoline for the inhibition of ns3 (hepatitis c)
US6642204B2 (en) Hepatitis C inhibitor tri-peptides
US7119072B2 (en) Macrocyclic peptides active against the hepatitis C virus
AU2003202348A1 (en) Heterocyclic tripeptides as hepatitis c inhibitors
WO2004101605A1 (en) Hepatitis c inhibiting compounds
CA2474031C (en) Heterocyclic tripeptides as hepatitis c inhibitors

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 1200501881

Country of ref document: VN

Ref document number: P-2005/0871

Country of ref document: YU

AK Designated states

Kind code of ref document: A1

Designated state(s): AE AG AL AM AT AU AZ BA BB BG BR BW BY BZ CA CH CN CO CR CU CZ DE DK DM DZ EC EE EG ES FI GB GD GE GH GM HR HU ID IL IN IS JP KE KG KP KR KZ LC LK LR LS LT LU LV MA MD MG MK MN MW MX MZ NA NI NO NZ OM PG PH PL PT RO RU SC SD SE SG SK SL SY TJ TM TN TR TT TZ UA UG US UZ VC VN YU ZA ZM ZW

AL Designated countries for regional patents

Kind code of ref document: A1

Designated state(s): BW GH GM KE LS MW MZ NA SD SL SZ TZ UG ZM ZW AM AZ BY KG KZ MD RU TJ TM AT BE BG CH CY CZ DE DK EE ES FI FR GB GR HU IE IT LU MC NL PL PT RO SE SI SK TR BF BJ CF CG CI CM GA GN GQ GW ML MR NE SN TD TG

121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application
DPEN Request for preliminary examination filed prior to expiration of 19th month from priority date (pct application filed from 20040101)
WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2004733750

Country of ref document: EP

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2005/08201

Country of ref document: ZA

Ref document number: 200508201

Country of ref document: ZA

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2522577

Country of ref document: CA

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 172013

Country of ref document: IL

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2006529495

Country of ref document: JP

Ref document number: 1020057022088

Country of ref document: KR

Ref document number: 12005502087

Country of ref document: PH

Ref document number: 05117348

Country of ref document: CO

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: PA/a/2005/012545

Country of ref document: MX

Ref document number: 20048137831

Country of ref document: CN

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 200501689

Country of ref document: EA

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2004240704

Country of ref document: AU

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 544076

Country of ref document: NZ

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 02624/KOLNP/2005

Country of ref document: IN

Ref document number: 2624/KOLNP/2005

Country of ref document: IN

WWP Wipo information: published in national office

Ref document number: 2004240704

Country of ref document: AU

WWP Wipo information: published in national office

Ref document number: 1020057022088

Country of ref document: KR

WWP Wipo information: published in national office

Ref document number: 2004733750

Country of ref document: EP

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: PI0410456

Country of ref document: BR

WWG Wipo information: grant in national office

Ref document number: 2004733750

Country of ref document: EP